CBSE Maths 10
CBSE Maths 10
CBSE Maths 10
e
Textbook for Class X
h
pu T
is
re R
bl
E
be C
o N
©
tt
no
ISBN 81-7450-634-9
First Edition ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
December 2006 Pausa 1928 No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval
system or transmitted, in any form or by any means, electronic,
Reprinted mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise without the prior
October 2007 Kartika 1929 permission of the publisher.
January 2009 Pausa 1930 This book is sold subject to the condition that it shall not, by way of
December 2009 Agrahayana 1931 trade, be lent, re-sold, hired out or otherwise disposed of without
e
the publisher’s consent, in any form of binding or cover other than
November 2010 Kartika 1932 that in which it is published.
January 2012 Pausa 1933 The correct price of this publication is the price printed on this
November 2012 Kartika 1934
h
page, Any revised price indicated by a rubber stamp or by a sticker
November 2013 Kartika 1935 or by any other means is incorrect and should be unacceptable.
pu T
PD 750T BS OFFICES OF THE PUBLICATION DIVISION, NCERT
is
NCERT Campus
© National Council of Educational
re R Sri Aurobindo Marg
Research and Training, 2006 New Delhi 110 016 Phone : 011-26562708
bl
108, 100 Feet Road
Hosdakere Halli Extension
Banashankari III Stage
E
Bengaluru 560 085 Phone : 080-26725740
CWC Campus
Opp. Dhankal Bus Stop
Panihati
Kolkata 700 114 Phone : 033-25530454
o N
CWC Complex
Maligaon
` 115.00 Guwahati 781 021 Phone : 0361-2674869
Publication Team
©
e
the legacy of bookish learning which continues to shape our system and causes a
gap between the school, home and community. The syllabi and textbooks developed
h
on the basis of NCF signify an attempt to implement this basic idea. They also
pu T
attempt to discourage rote learning and the maintenance of sharp boundaries between
is
different subject areas. We hope these measures will take us significantly further in
re R
the direction of a child-centred system of education outlined in the National Policy
on Education (1986).
bl
The success of this effort depends on the steps that school principals and teachers
E
will take to encourage children to reflect on their own learning and to pursue
imaginative activities and questions. We must recognise that, given space, time and
freedom, children generate new knowledge by engaging with the information passed
be C
on to them by adults. Treating the prescribed textbook as the sole basis of examination
is one of the key reasons why other resources and sites of learning are ignored.
o N
calendar so that the required number of teaching days are actually devoted to teaching.
The methods used for teaching and evaluation will also determine how effective this
textbook proves for making children’s life at school a happy experience, rather than
a source of stress or boredom. Syllabus designers have tried to address the problem
of curricular burden by restructuring and reorienting knowledge at different stages
with greater consideration for child psychology and the time available for teaching.
The textbook attempts to enhance this endeavour by giving higher priority and space
to opportunities for contemplation and wondering, discussion in small groups, and
activities requiring hands-on experience.
tt
Mathematics, Professor J.V. Narlikar and the Chief Advisors for this book, Professor
P. Sinclair of IGNOU, New Delhi and Professor G.P. Dikshit (Retd.) of Lucknow
University, Lucknow for guiding the work of this committee. Several teachers
iv
e
Professor G.P. Deshpande, for their valuable time and contribution. As an organisation
committed to systemic reform and continuous improvement in the quality of its
products, NCERT welcomes comments and suggestions which will enable us to
h
undertake further revision and refinement.
pu T
is
re R Director
New Delhi National Council of Educational
bl
15 November 2006 Research and Training
E
be C
o N
©
tt
no
Preface
Through the years, from the time of the Kothari Commission, there have been
several committees looking at ways of making the school curriculum meaningful
e
and enjoyable for the learners. Based on the understanding developed over the
years, a National Curriculum Framework (NCF) was finalised in 2005. As part of
h
this exercise, a National Focus Group on Teaching of Mathematics was formed. Its
pu T
report, which came in 2005, highlighted a constructivist approach to the teaching
is
and learning of mathematics.
re R
The essence of this approach is that children already know, and do some
mathematics very naturally in their surroundings, before they even join school. The
bl
syllabus, teaching approach, textbooks etc., should build on this knowledge in a way
E
that allows children to enjoy mathematics, and to realise that mathematics is more
about a way of reasoning than about mechanically applying formulae and algorithms.
The students and teachers need to perceive mathematics as something natural and
be C
linked to the world around us. While teaching mathematics, the focus should be on
helping children to develop the ability to particularise and generalise, to solve and
o N
pose meaningful problems, to look for patterns and relationships, and to apply the
logical thinking behind mathematical proof. And, all this in an environment that the
children relate to, without overloading them.
This is the philosophy with which the mathematics syllabus from Class I to
©
Class XII was developed, and which the textbook development committee has tried
to realise in the present textbook. More specifically, while creating the textbook, the
following broad guidelines have been kept in mind.
z The matter needs to be linked to what the child has studied before, and to
her experiences.
z The language used in the book, including that for ‘word problems’, must be
clear, simple and unambiguous.
z Concepts/processes should be introduced through situations from the
tt
children’s environment.
z For each concept/process give several examples and exercises, but not of
the same kind. This ensures that the children use the concept/process again
no
and again, but in varying contexts. Here ‘several’ should be within reason,
not overloading the child.
z Encourage the children to see, and come out with, diverse solutions to
problems.
vi
e
develop a clear and logical way of expressing her arguments.
z All geometric constructions should be accompanied by an analysis of the
h
construction and a proof for the steps taken to do the required construction.
pu T
Accordingly, the children would be trained to do the same while doing
is
constructions.
re R
z Add such small anecdotes, pictures, cartoons and historical remarks at
several places which the children would find interesting.
bl
z Include optional exercises for the more interested learners. These would
E
not be tested in the examinations.
z Give answers to all exercises, and solutions/hints for those that the children
be C
may require.
z Whenever possible, propagate constitutional values.
As you will see while studying this textbook, these points have been kept in mind
o N
by the Textbook Development Committee. The book has particularly been created
with the view to giving children space to explore mathematics and develop the abilities
to reason mathematically. Further, two special appendices have been given — Proofs
in Mathematics, and Mathematical Modelling. These are placed in the book for
©
interested students to study, and are only optional reading at present. These topics
may be considered for inclusion in the main syllabi in due course of time.
As in the past, this textbook is also a team effort. However, what is unusual
about the team this time is that teachers from different kinds of schools have been
an integral part at each stage of the development. We are also assuming that teachers
will contribute continuously to the process in the classroom by formulating examples
and exercises contextually suited to the children in their particular classrooms. Finally,
we hope that teachers and learners would send comments for improving the textbook
tt
to the NCERT.
PARVIN SINCLAIR
G.P. DIKSHIT
no
Chief Advisors
Textbook Development Committee
Textbook Development Committee
CHAIRPERSON, ADVISORY GROUP IN SCIENCE AND MATHEMATICS
e
J.V. Narlikar, Emeritus Professor, Inter-University Centre for Astronomy & Astrophysics
(IUCAA), Ganeshkhind, Pune University, Pune
h
CHIEF ADVISORS
pu T
P. Sinclair, Professor, School of Sciences, IGNOU, New Delhi
is
G.P. Dikshit, Professor (Retd.), Lucknow University, Lucknow
re R
CHIEF COORDINATOR
bl
Hukum Singh, Professor and Head, DESM, NCERT, New Delhi
E
MEMBERS
Anjali Lal, PGT, DAV Public School, Sector-14, Gurgaon
be C
e
participants of the Textbook Review Workshop:
Mala Mani, TGT, Amity International School, Sector-44, Noida; Meera
h
Mahadevan, TGT, Atomic Energy Central School, No. 4, Anushakti Nagar, Mumbai;
pu T
Rashmi Rana, TGT, D.A.V. Public School, Pushpanjali Enclave, Pitampura, Delhi;
is
Mohammad Qasim, TGT, Anglo Arabic Senior Secondary School, Ajmeri Gate, Delhi;
re R
S.C. Rauto, TGT, Central School for Tibetans, Happy Valley, Mussoorie; Rakesh
Kaushik, TGT, Sainik School, Kunjpura, Karnal; Ashok Kumar Gupta, TGT, Jawahar
bl
Navodaya Vidyalaya, Dudhnoi, Distt. Goalpara; Sankar Misra, TGT, Demonstration
E
Multipurpose School, RIE, Bhubaneswar; Uaday Singh, Lecturer, Department of
Mathematics, B.H.U., Varanasi; B.R. Handa, Emeritus Professor, IIT, New Delhi;
be C
Monika Singh, Lecturer, Sri Ram College (University of Delhi), Lajpat Nagar,
New Delhi; G. Sri Hari Babu, TGT, Jawahar Navodaya Vidyalaya, Sirpur, Kagaz
Nagar, Adilabad; Ajay Kumar Singh, TGT, Ramjas Sr. Secondary School No. 3,
o N
e
Preface v
1. Real Numbers 1
h
1.1 Introduction 1
pu T
1.2 Euclid’s Division Lemma 2
is
1.3
re R The Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic 7
1.4 Revisiting Irrational Numbers 11
bl
1.5 Revisiting Rational Numbers and Their Decimal Expansions 15
E
1.6 Summary 18
2. Polynomials 20
be C
2.1 Introduction 20
2.2 Geometrical Meaning of the Zeroes of a Polynomial 21
o N
4. Quadratic Equations 70
4.1 Introduction 70
4.2 Quadratic Equations 71
x
e
5.1 Introduction 93
5.2 Arithmetic Progressions 95
h
5.3 nth Term of an AP 100
pu T
5.4 Sum of First n Terms of an AP 107
is
5.5
re R Summary 116
6. Triangles 117
bl
6.1 Introduction 117
E
6.2 Similar Figures 118
6.3 Similarity of Triangles 123
be C
e
10.1 Introduction 206
10.2 Tangent to a Circle 207
h
10.3 Number of Tangents from a Point on a Circle 209
pu T
10.4 Summary 215
is
11. Constructions
re R 216
11.1 Introduction 216
bl
11.2 Division of a Line Segment 216
E
11.3 Construction of Tangents to a Circle 220
11.4 Summary 222
be C
e
15.2 Probability — A Theoretical Approach 296
15.3 Summary 312
h
Appendix A1 : Proofs in Mathematics 313
pu T
A1.1 Introduction 313
is
A1.2 Mathematical Statements Revisited
re R 313
A1.3 Deductive Reasoning 316
bl
A1.4 Conjectures, Theorems, Proofs and Mathematical Reasoning 318
E
A1.5 Negation of a Statement 323
A1.6 Converse of a Statement 326
be C
d
he
REAL NUMBERS 1
is
1.1 Introduction
bl
In Class IX, you began your exploration of the world of real numbers and encountered
irrational numbers. We continue our discussion on real numbers in this chapter. We
begin with two very important properties of positive integers in Sections 1.2 and 1.3,
pu
namely the Euclid’s division algorithm and the Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic.
Euclid’s division algorithm, as the name suggests, has to do with divisibility of
integers. Stated simply, it says any positive integer a can be divided by another positive
be T
integer b in such a way that it leaves a remainder r that is smaller than b. Many of you
re
probably recognise this as the usual long division process. Although this result is quite
o R
easy to state and understand, it has many applications related to the divisibility properties
of integers. We touch upon a few of them, and use it mainly to compute the HCF of
two positive integers.
tt E
can be expressed as a product of primes in a unique way —this important fact is the
Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic. Again, while it is a result that is easy to state and
understand, it has some very deep and significant applications in the field of mathematics.
no N
We use the Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic for two main applications. First, we
use it to prove the irrationality of many of the numbers you studied in Class IX, such as
2 , 3 and 5 . Second, we apply this theorem to explore when exactly the decimal
p
expansion of a rational number, say q ( q ≠ 0) , is terminating and when it is non-
©
d
fight, he pulled the basket with eggs and dashed it on the floor. The eggs broke.
The trader requested the Panchayat to ask the idler to pay for the broken eggs.
he
The Panchayat asked the trader how many eggs were broken. He gave the
following response:
If counted in pairs, one will remain;
is
If counted in threes, two will remain;
If counted in fours, three will remain;
If counted in fives, four will remain;
bl
If counted in sixes, five will remain;
If counted in sevens, nothing will remain;
pu
My basket cannot accomodate more than 150 eggs.
So, how many eggs were there? Let us try and solve the puzzle. Let the number
be T
of eggs be a. Then working backwards, we see that a is less than or equal to 150:
re
If counted in sevens, nothing will remain, which translates to a = 7p + 0, for
o R
number w.
If counted in fours, three will remain. It translates to a = 4s + 3, for some natural
C
number s.
If counted in threes, two will remain. It translates to a = 3t + 2, for some natural
no N
number t.
If counted in pairs, one will remain. It translates to a = 2 u + 1, for some natural
number u.
©
That is, in each case, we have a and a positive integer b (in our example,
b takes values 7, 6, 5, 4, 3 and 2, respectively) which divides a and leaves a remainder
r (in our case, r is 0, 5, 4, 3, 2 and 1, respectively), that is smaller than b. The
* This is modified form of a puzzle given in ‘Numeracy Counts!’ by A. Rampal, and others.
R EAL NUMBERS 3
moment we write down such equations we are using Euclid’s division lemma,
which is given in Theorem 1.1.
Getting back to our puzzle, do you have any idea how you will solve it? Yes! You
must look for the multiples of 7 which satisfy all the conditions. By trial and error
d
(using the concept of LCM), you will find he had 119 eggs.
he
In order to get a feel for what Euclid’s division lemma is, consider the following
pairs of integers:
17, 6; 5, 12; 20, 4
is
Like we did in the example, we can write the following relations for each such
pair:
bl
17 = 6 × 2 + 5 (6 goes into 17 twice and leaves a remainder 5)
5 = 12 × 0 + 5 (This relation holds since 12 is larger than 5)
pu
20 = 4 × 5 + 0 (Here 4 goes into 20 five-times and leaves no remainder)
That is, for each pair of positive integers a and b, we have found whole numbers
be T
integers a and b?
(i) 10, 3; (ii) 4, 19; (iii) 81, 3
C
Did you notice that q and r are unique? These are the only integers satisfying the
conditions a = bq + r, where 0 ≤ r < b. You may have also realised that this is nothing
no N
but a restatement of the long division process you have been doing all these years, and
that the integers q and r are called the quotient and remainder, respectively.
A formal statement of this result is as follows :
©
d
of the 9th century Persian mathematician
al-Khwarizmi. In fact, even the word ‘algebra’
he
is derived from a book, he wrote, called Hisab
al-jabr w’al-muqabala.
A lemma is a proven statement used for Muhammad ibn Musa al-Khwarizmi
proving another statement.
is
(A.D. 780 – 850)
bl
and b is the largest positive integer d that divides both a and b.
Let us see how the algorithm works, through an example first. Suppose we need
pu
to find the HCF of the integers 455 and 42. We start with the larger integer, that is,
455. Then we use Euclid’s lemma to get
455 = 42 × 10 + 35
be T
Now consider the divisor 42 and the remainder 35, and apply the division lemma
re
to get
o R
42 = 35 × 1 + 7
Now consider the divisor 35 and the remainder 7, and apply the division lemma
to get
tt E
35 = 7 × 5 + 0
Notice that the remainder has become zero, and we cannot proceed any further.
C
We claim that the HCF of 455 and 42 is the divisor at this stage, i.e., 7. You can easily
verify this by listing all the factors of 455 and 42. Why does this method work? It
works because of the following result.
no N
Step 1 : Apply Euclid’s division lemma, to c and d. So, we find whole numbers, q and
r such that c = dq + r, 0 ≤ r < d.
Step 2 : If r = 0, d is the HCF of c and d. If r ≠ 0, apply the division lemma to d and r.
Step 3 : Continue the process till the remainder is zero. The divisor at this stage will
be the required HCF.
R EAL NUMBERS 5
This algorithm works because HCF (c, d) = HCF (d, r) where the symbol
HCF (c, d) denotes the HCF of c and d, etc.
Example 1 : Use Euclid’s algorithm to find the HCF of 4052 and 12576.
d
Solution :
Step 1 : Since 12576 > 4052, we apply the division lemma to 12576 and 4052, to get
he
12576 = 4052 × 3 + 420
Step 2 : Since the remainder 420 ≠ 0, we apply the division lemma to 4052 and 420, to
get
4052 = 420 × 9 + 272
Step 3 : We consider the new divisor 420 and the new remainder 272, and apply the
is
division lemma to get
420 = 272 × 1 + 148
bl
We consider the new divisor 272 and the new remainder 148, and apply the division
lemma to get
272 = 148 × 1 + 124
We consider the new divisor 148 and the new remainder 124, and apply the division
pu
lemma to get
148 = 124 × 1 + 24
be T
We consider the new divisor 124 and the new remainder 24, and apply the division
lemma to get
re
124 = 24 × 5 + 4
o R
We consider the new divisor 24 and the new remainder 4, and apply the division
lemma to get
24 = 4 × 6 + 0
tt E
The remainder has now become zero, so our procedure stops. Since the divisor at this
stage is 4, the HCF of 12576 and 4052 is 4.
C
Notice that 4 = HCF (24, 4) = HCF (124, 24) = HCF (148, 124) =
HCF (272, 148) = HCF (420, 272) = HCF (4052, 420) = HCF (12576, 4052).
no N
Euclid’s division algorithm is not only useful for calculating the HCF of very
large numbers, but also because it is one of the earliest examples of an algorithm that
a computer had been programmed to carry out.
Remarks :
©
1. Euclid’s division lemma and algorithm are so closely interlinked that people often
call former as the division algorithm also.
2. Although Euclid’s Division Algorithm is stated for only positive integers, it can be
extended for all integers except zero, i.e., b ≠ 0. However, we shall not discuss this
aspect here.
6 MATHEMATICS
Example 2 : Show that every positive even integer is of the form 2q, and that every
d
positive odd integer is of the form 2q + 1, where q is some integer.
Solution : Let a be any positive integer and b = 2. Then, by Euclid’s algorithm,
he
a = 2q + r, for some integer q ≥ 0, and r = 0 or r = 1, because 0 ≤ r < 2. So,
a = 2q or 2q + 1.
If a is of the form 2q, then a is an even integer. Also, a positive integer can be
either even or odd. Therefore, any positive odd integer is of the form 2q + 1.
is
Example 3 : Show that any positive odd integer is of the form 4q + 1 or 4q + 3, where
q is some integer.
bl
Solution : Let us start with taking a, where a is a positive odd integer. We apply the
division algorithm with a and b = 4.
pu
Since 0 ≤ r < 4, the possible remainders are 0, 1, 2 and 3.
That is, a can be 4q, or 4q + 1, or 4q + 2, or 4q + 3, where q is the quotient.
be T
However, since a is odd, a cannot be 4q or 4q + 2 (since they are both divisible by 2).
Therefore, any odd integer is of the form 4q + 1 or 4q + 3.
re
o R
Example 4 : A sweetseller has 420 kaju barfis and 130 badam barfis. She wants to
stack them in such a way that each stack has the same number, and they take up the
tt E
least area of the tray. What is the number of that can be placed in each stack for this
purpose?
C
Solution : This can be done by trial and error. But to do it systematically, we find
HCF (420, 130). Then this number will give the maximum number of barfis in each
stack and the number of stacks will then be the least. The area of the tray that is used
no N
130 = 30 × 4 + 10
30 = 10 × 3 + 0
So, the HCF of 420 and 130 is 10.
Therefore, the sweetseller can make stacks of 10 for both kinds of barfi.
R EAL NUMBERS 7
EXERCISE 1.1
1. Use Euclid’s division algorithm to find the HCF of :
(i) 135 and 225 (ii) 196 and 38220 (iii) 867 and 255
2. Show that any positive odd integer is of the form 6q + 1, or 6q + 3, or 6q + 5, where q is
d
some integer.
3. An army contingent of 616 members is to march behind an army band of 32 members in
he
a parade. The two groups are to march in the same number of columns. What is the
maximum number of columns in which they can march?
4. Use Euclid’s division lemma to show that the square of any positive integer is either of
the form 3m or 3m + 1 for some integer m.
is
[Hint : Let x be any positive integer then it is of the form 3q, 3q + 1 or 3q + 2. Now square
each of these and show that they can be rewritten in the form 3m or 3m + 1.]
5. Use Euclid’s division lemma to show that the cube of any positive integer is of the form
bl
9m, 9m + 1 or 9m + 8.
Now, let us try and look at natural numbers from the other direction. That is, can any
natural number be obtained by multiplying prime numbers? Let us see.
re
o R
2 × 3 × 7 × 11 × 23 = 10626 2 3 × 3 × 73 = 8232
2 2 × 3 × 7 × 11 × 23 = 21252
no N
and so on.
Now, let us suppose your collection of primes includes all the possible primes.
What is your guess about the size of this collection? Does it contain only a finite
number of integers, or infinitely many? Infact, there are infinitely many primes. So, if
©
we combine all these primes in all possible ways, we will get an infinite collection of
numbers, all the primes and all possible products of primes. The question is – can we
produce all the composite numbers this way? What do you think? Do you think that
there may be a composite number which is not the product of powers of primes?
Before we answer this, let us factorise positive integers, that is, do the opposite of
what we have done so far.
8 MATHEMATICS
We are going to use the factor tree with which you are all familiar. Let us take
some large number, say, 32760, and factorise it as shown :
32760
d
2 16380
he
2 8190
is
2 4095
bl
3 1365
pu
3 455
be T
5 91
re
o R
7 13
tt E
you have to check that 3803 and 3607 are primes! (Try it out for several other natural
numbers yourself.) This leads us to a conjecture that every composite number can be
written as the product of powers of primes. In fact, this statement is true, and is called
the Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic because of its basic crucial importance
©
d
was given by Carl Friedrich Gauss in his Disquisitiones
Arithmeticae.
he
Carl Friedrich Gauss is often referred to as the ‘Prince of
Mathematicians’ and is considered one of the three
greatest mathematicians of all time, along with Archimedes
and Newton. He has made fundamental contributions to Carl Friedrich Gauss
is
both mathematics and science. (1777 – 1855)
bl
The Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic says that every composite number
can be factorised as a product of primes. Actually it says more. It says that given
any composite number it can be factorised as a product of prime numbers in a
pu
‘unique’ way, except for the order in which the primes occur. That is, given any
composite number there is one and only one way to write it as a product of primes,
as long as we are not particular about the order in which the primes occur. So, for
be T
following form:
The prime factorisation of a natural number is unique, except for the order
of its factors.
tt E
≤ . . . ≤ pn. If we combine the same primes, we will get powers of primes. For example,
32760 = 2 × 2 × 2 × 3 × 3 × 5 × 7 × 13 = 23 × 32 × 5 × 7 × 13
no N
Once we have decided that the order will be ascending, then the way the number
is factorised, is unique.
The Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic has many applications, both within
©
not possible because 4n = (2)2n; so the only prime in the factorisation of 4n is 2. So, the
uniqueness of the Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic guarantees that there are no
other primes in the factorisation of 4n. So, there is no natural number n for which 4 n
ends with the digit zero.
d
You have already learnt how to find the HCF and LCM of two positive integers
using the Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic in earlier classes, without realising it!
he
This method is also called the prime factorisation method. Let us recall this method
through an example.
Example 6 : Find the LCM and HCF of 6 and 20 by the prime factorisation method.
6 = 21 × 31 and 20 = 2 × 2 × 5 = 22 × 51.
is
Solution : We have :
You can find HCF(6, 20) = 2 and LCM(6, 20) = 2 × 2 × 3 × 5 = 60, as done in your
earlier classes.
bl
Note that HCF(6, 20) = 21 = Product of the smallest power of each common
prime factor in the numbers.
pu
LCM (6, 20) = 22 × 3 1 × 51 = Product of the greatest power of each prime factor,
involved in the numbers.
be T
From the example above, you might have noticed that HCF(6, 20) × LCM(6, 20)
= 6 × 20. In fact, we can verify that for any two positive integers a and b,
re
HCF (a, b) × LCM (a, b) = a × b. We can use this result to find the LCM of two
o R
positive integers, if we have already found the HCF of the two positive integers.
Example 7 : Find the HCF of 96 and 404 by the prime factorisation method. Hence,
tt E
96 = 25 × 3, 404 = 2 2 × 101
Therefore, the HCF of these two integers is 22 = 4.
no N
96 × 404 96 × 404
Also, LCM (96, 404) = = = 9696
HCF(96, 404) 4
©
Example 8 : Find the HCF and LCM of 6, 72 and 120, using the prime factorisation
method.
Solution : We have :
6 = 2 × 3, 72 = 2 3 × 32, 120 = 2 3 × 3 × 5
Here, 21 and 31 are the smallest powers of the common factors 2 and 3, respectively.
R EAL NUMBERS 11
d
So, LCM (6, 72, 120) = 23 × 32 × 51 = 360
Remark : Notice, 6 × 72 × 120 ≠ HCF (6, 72, 120) × LCM (6, 72, 120). So, the
he
product of three numbers is not equal to the product of their HCF and LCM.
EXERCISE 1.2
is
1. Express each number as a product of its prime factors:
(i) 140 (ii) 156 (iii) 3825 (iv) 5005 (v) 7429
bl
2. Find the LCM and HCF of the following pairs of integers and verify that LCM × HCF =
product of the two numbers.
(i) 26 and 91 (ii) 510 and 92 (iii) 336 and 54
pu
3. Find the LCM and HCF of the following integers by applying the prime factorisation
method.
be T
5. Check whether 6n can end with the digit 0 for any natural number n.
6. Explain why 7 × 11 × 13 + 13 and 7 × 6 × 5 × 4 × 3 × 2 × 1 + 5 are composite numbers.
tt E
7. There is a circular path around a sports field. Sonia takes 18 minutes to drive one round
of the field, while Ravi takes 12 minutes for the same. Suppose they both start at the
same point and at the same time, and go in the same direction. After how many minutes
C
In Class IX, you were introduced to irrational numbers and many of their properties.
You studied about their existence and how the rationals and the irrationals together
made up the real numbers. You even studied how to locate irrationals on the number
©
line. However, we did not prove that they were irrationals. In this section, we will
prove that 2 , 3 , 5 and, in general, p is irrational, where p is a prime. One of
the theorems, we use in our proof, is the Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic.
p
Recall, a number ‘s’ is called irrational if it cannot be written in the form ,
q
where p and q are integers and q ≠ 0. Some examples of irrational numbers, with
12 MATHEMATICS
d
proof is based on the Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic.
he
Theorem 1.3 : Let p be a prime number. If p divides a2, then p divides a, where
a is a positive integer.
*Proof : Let the prime factorisation of a be as follows :
is
a = p 1p 2 . . . p n, where p 1,p2, . . ., p n are primes, not necessarily distinct.
Therefore, a 2 = ( p1 p 2 . . . pn)( p 1 p 2 . . . p n) = p21 p22 . . . p2n.
bl
Now, we are given that p divides a 2. Therefore, from the Fundamental Theorem of
Arithmetic, it follows that p is one of the prime factors of a2. However, using the
uniqueness part of the Fundamental Theorem of Arithmetic, we realise that the only
pu
prime factors of a2 are p1, p 2, . . ., p n. So p is one of p 1, p2 , . . ., p n.
Now, since a = p1 p2 . . . pn , p divides a.
be T
a
factor to get 2 = , where a and b are coprime.
b
So, b 2 = a.
©
d
But this contradicts the fact that a and b have no common factors other than 1.
This contradiction has arisen because of our incorrect assumption that 2 is rational.
he
So, we conclude that 2 is irrational.
is
Solution : Let us assume, to the contrary, that 3 is rational.
a
That is, we can find integers a and b (≠ 0) such that ⋅ 3 =
bl
b
Suppose a and b have a common factor other than 1, then we can divide by the
common factor, and assume that a and b are coprime.
pu
So, b 3 = a ⋅
Squaring on both sides, and rearranging, we get 3b2 = a2.
be T
This means that b 2 is divisible by 3, and so b is also divisible by 3 (using Theorem 1.3
with p = 3).
C
This contradiction has arisen because of our incorrect assumption that 3 is rational.
So, we conclude that 3 is irrational.
In Class IX, we mentioned that :
©
d
b
a
Therefore, 5 − = 3 ⋅
he
b
a 5b − a
Rearranging this equation, we get 3 = 5 – = ⋅
b b
a
Since a and b are integers, we get 5 – is rational, and so 3 is rational.
is
b
But this contradicts the fact that 3 is irrational.
This contradiction has arisen because of our incorrect assumption that 5 – 3 is
bl
rational.
a
Since 3, a and b are integers, is rational, and so 2 is rational.
3b
C
EXERCISE 1.3
d
q
p
decimal expansion of is terminating and when it is non-terminating repeating
q
he
(or recurring). We do so by considering several examples.
Let us consider the following rational numbers :
(i) 0.375 (ii) 0.104 (iii) 0.0875 (iv) 23.3408.
is
375 375 104 104
Now (i) 0.375 = = (ii) 0.104 = =
1000 10 3 1000 10 3
bl
875 875 233408 233408
(iii) 0.0875 = = 4 (iv) 23.3408 = =
10000 10 10000 10 4
As one would expect, they can all be expressed as rational numbers whose
pu
denominators are powers of 10. Let us try and cancel the common factors between
the numerator and denominator and see what we get :
be T
375 3 × 53 3 104 13 × 23 13
(i) 0.375 = = 3 = 3 (ii) 0.104 = = =
re
103
2 ×5 3
2 10 3 2 3 × 53 53
o R
Do you see any pattern? It appears that, we have converted a real number
p
whose decimal expansion terminates into a rational number of the form , where p
C
q
and q are coprime, and the prime factorisation of the denominator (that is, q) has only
powers of 2, or powers of 5, or both. We should expect the denominator to look like
no N
rational number whose denominator is a power of 10. Also the only prime factors of 10
are 2 and 5. So, cancelling out the common factors between the numerator and the
p
denominator, we find that this real number is a rational number of the form , where
q
the prime factorisation of q is of the form 2n5 m, and n, m are some non-negative integers.
Let us write our result formally:
16 MATHEMATICS
d
You are probably wondering what happens the other way round in Theorem 1.5.
p
he
That is, if we have a rational number of the form , and the prime factorisation of q
q p
is of the form 2n5 m, where n, m are non negative integers, then does have a
q
terminating decimal expansion?
is
Let us see if there is some obvious reason why this is true. You will surely agree
a
that any rational number of the form , where b is a power of 10, will have a terminating
b
decimal expansion. So it seems to make sense to convert a rational number of the
bl
p a
form , where q is of the form 2n5 m , to an equivalent rational number of the form ,
q b
pu
where b is a power of 10. Let us go back to our examples above and work backwards.
3 3 3 × 53 375
= 3 = 3 = 3 = 0.375
be T
(i)
8 2 2 ×5 3
10
re
13 13 13 × 23 104
o R
(ii) = = = = 0.104
125 53 23 × 53 103
7 7 7 × 53 875
tt E
(iii) = 4 = 4 = 4 = 0.0875
80 2 × 5 2 × 5 4
10
(iv) = = = = 23.3408
625 54 2 4 × 54 10 4
no N
So, these examples show us how we can convert a rational number of the form
p , where q is of the form 2 n5 m, to an equivalent rational number of the form a ,
q b
where b is a power of 10. Therefore, the decimal expansion of such a rational number
©
d
1 28
textbook, namely, . Here, remainders are 3, 2, 6, 4, 5, 1, 3, 20
7
14
he
2, 6, 4, 5, 1, . . . and divisor is 7. 60
Notice that the denominator here, i.e., 7 is clearly not of 56
the form 2 n5m . Therefore, from Theorems 1.5 and 1.6, we 40
35
is
1
know that will not have a terminating decimal expansion. 50
7 49
Hence, 0 will not show up as a remainder (Why?), and the 10
bl
remainders will start repeating after a certain stage. So, we 7
will have a block of digits, namely, 142857, repeating in the
30
1
quotient of .
pu
7 1
What we have seen, in the case of , is true for any rational number not covered
7
be T
q
of q is not of the form 2n5 m, where n, m are non-negative integers. Then, x has a
decimal expansion which is non-terminating repeating (recurring).
tt E
From the discussion above, we can conclude that the decimal expansion of
every rational number is either terminating or non-terminating repeating.
C
EXERCISE 1.4
no N
1. Without actually performing the long division, state whether the following rational
numbers will have a terminating decimal expansion or a non-terminating repeating decimal
expansion:
13 17 64 15
©
35 77
(ix) (x)
50 210
18 MATHEMATICS
2. Write down the decimal expansions of those rational numbers in Question 1 above
which have terminating decimal expansions.
3. The following real numbers have decimal expansions as given below. In each case,
decide whether they are rational or not. If they are rational, and of the form p , what can
q
d
you say about the prime factors of q?
(i) 43.123456789 (ii) 0.120120012000120000. . . (iii) 43.123456789
he
1.6 Summary
In this chapter, you have studied the following points:
1. Euclid’s division lemma :
is
Given positive integers a and b, there exist whole numbers q and r satisfying a = bq + r,
0 ≤ r < b.
bl
2. Euclid’s division algorithm : This is based on Euclid’s division lemma. According to this,
the HCF of any two positive integers a and b, with a > b, is obtained as follows:
Step 1 : Apply the division lemma to find q and r where a = bq + r, 0 ≤ r < b.
pu
Step 2 : If r = 0, the HCF is b. If r ≠ 0, apply Euclid’s lemma to b and r.
be T
Step 3 : Continue the process till the remainder is zero. The divisor at this stage will be
HCF (a, b). Also, HCF(a, b) = HCF(b, r).
re
o R
q
2n5m, where n, m are non-negative integers.
7. Let x = p be a rational number, such that the prime factorisation of q is of the form 2n5m,
q
©
where n, m are non-negative integers. Then x has a decimal expansion which terminates.
p
8. Let x = be a rational number, such that the prime factorisation of q is not of the form
q
2n 5m , where n, m are non-negative integers. Then x has a decimal expansion which is
non-terminating repeating (recurring).
R EAL NUMBERS 19
d
HCF ( p, q, r) × LCM (p, q, r) ≠ p × q × r, where p, q, r are positive integers
(see Example 8). However, the following results hold good for three numbers
he
p, q and r :
p ⋅q ⋅r ⋅HCF(p , q, r )
LCM (p, q, r) =
HCF( p , q) ⋅ HCF( q ,r ) ⋅ HCF( p, r )
is
p ⋅q ⋅r ⋅ LCM(p, q, r )
HCF (p, q, r) =
LCM( p, q) ⋅ LCM(q, r ) ⋅ LCM( p , r )
bl
pu
be T
re
o R
tt E
C
no N
©
20 MATHEMATICS
d
he
POLYNOMIALS 2
is
2.1 Introduction
bl
In Class IX, you have studied polynomials in one variable and their degrees. Recall
that if p(x) is a polynomial in x, the highest power of x in p(x) is called the degree of
pu
the polynomial p(x). For example, 4x + 2 is a polynomial in the variable x of
degree 1, 2y2 – 3y + 4 is a polynomial in the variable y of degree 2, 5x3 – 4x2 + x – 2
be T
3 4
is a polynomial in the variable x of degree 3 and 7u6 – u + 4 u 2 + u − 8 is a polynomial
2
re
o R
1 1
in the variable u of degree 6. Expressions like , x +2, etc., are
x−1 x + 2x + 3
2
not polynomials.
tt E
2
3 x + 5, y + 2 , x − , 3z + 4, u + 1 , etc., are all linear polynomials. Polynomials
11 3
such as 2x + 5 – x2, x3 + 1, etc., are not linear polynomials.
no N
u 2 1
y2 – 2, 2 − x2 + 3 x, − 2u2 + 5, 5v2 − v, 4z 2 + are some examples of
3 3 7
quadratic polynomials (whose coefficients are real numbers). More generally, any
quadratic polynomial in x is of the form ax 2 + bx + c, where a, b, c are real numbers
and a ≠ 0. A polynomial of degree 3 is called a cubic polynomial. Some examples of
a cubic polynomial are 2 – x3, x3, 2 x 3 , 3 – x2 + x3 , 3x3 – 2x2 + x – 1. In fact, the most
general form of a cubic polynomial is
ax3 + bx 2 + cx + d,
d
where, a, b, c, d are real numbers and a ≠ 0.
Now consider the polynomial p(x) = x2 – 3x – 4. Then, putting x = 2 in the
he
polynomial, we get p(2) = 22 – 3 × 2 – 4 = – 6. The value ‘– 6’, obtained by replacing
x by 2 in x2 – 3x – 4, is the value of x2 – 3x – 4 at x = 2. Similarly, p(0) is the value of
p(x) at x = 0, which is – 4.
If p(x) is a polynomial in x, and if k is any real number, then the value obtained by
is
replacing x by k in p(x), is called the value of p(x) at x = k, and is denoted by p(k).
What is the value of p(x) = x2 –3x – 4 at x = –1? We have :
bl
p(–1) = (–1) 2 –{3 × (–1)} – 4 = 0
Also, note that p(4) = 4 2 – (3 × 4) – 4 = 0.
As p(–1) = 0 and p(4) = 0, –1 and 4 are called the zeroes of the quadratic
pu
polynomial x2 – 3x – 4. More generally, a real number k is said to be a zero of a
polynomial p(x), if p(k) = 0.
be T
You have already studied in Class IX, how to find the zeroes of a linear
polynomial. For example, if k is a zero of p(x) = 2x + 3, then p(k) = 0 gives us
re
o R
3
2k + 3 = 0, i.e., k = − ⋅
2
−b
In general, if k is a zero of p(x) = ax + b, then p(k) = ak + b = 0, i.e., k = ⋅
tt E
a
−b − (Constant term)
So, the zero of the linear polynomial ax + b is = .
a Coefficient of x
C
Thus, the zero of a linear polynomial is related to its coefficients. Does this
happen in the case of other polynomials too? For example, are the zeroes of a quadratic
no N
Consider first a linear polynomial ax + b, a ≠ 0. You have studied in Class IX that the
graph of y = ax + b is a straight line. For example, the graph of y = 2x + 3 is a straight
line passing through the points (– 2, –1) and (2, 7).
d
x –2 2
y = 2x + 3 –1 7
he
From Fig. 2.1, you can see
that the graph of y = 2x + 3
is
intersects the x - axis mid-way
between x = –1 and x = – 2,
bl
3
⎝ 2 ⎠
You also know that the zero of
pu
3
2x + 3 is − . Thus, the zero of
2
be T
⎛ −b ⎞
C
straight line which intersects the x-axis at exactly one point, namely, ⎜ , 0 ⎟ .
⎝ a ⎠
Therefore, the linear polynomial ax + b, a ≠ 0, has exactly one zero, namely, the
no N
* Plotting of graphs of quadratic or cubic polynomials is not meant to be done by the students,
nor is to be evaluated.
Table 2.1
x –2 –1 0 1 2 3 4 5
y = x2 – 3x – 4 6 0 –4 –6 –6 –4 0 6
d
If we locate the points listed
he
above on a graph paper and draw
the graph, it will actually look like
the one given in Fig. 2.2.
is
In fact, for any quadratic
polynomial ax2 + bx + c, a ≠ 0, the
graph of the corresponding
bl
equation y = ax 2 + bx + c has one
of the two shapes either open
upwards like or open
pu
downwards like depending on
whether a > 0 or a < 0. (These
be T
This fact is true for any quadratic polynomial, i.e., the zeroes of a quadratic
polynomial ax2 + bx + c, a ≠ 0, are precisely the x -coordinates of the points where the
parabola representing y = ax 2 + bx + c intersects the x-axis.
From our observation earlier about the shape of the graph of y = ax 2 + bx + c, the
following three cases can happen:
Case (i) : Here, the graph cuts x-axis at two distinct points A and A′.
The x-coordinates of A and A′ are the two zeroes of the quadratic polynomial
2
ax + bx + c in this case (see Fig. 2.3).
d
he
is
bl
pu
Fig. 2.3
be T
Case (ii) : Here, the graph cuts the x-axis at exactly one point, i.e., at two coincident
points. So, the two points A and A′ of Case (i) coincide here to become one point A
re
Fig. 2.4
The x -coordinate of A is the only zero for the quadratic polynomial ax 2 + bx + c
in this case.
Case (iii) : Here, the graph is either completely above the x -axis or completely below
the x -axis. So, it does not cut the x - axis at any point (see Fig. 2.5).
d
he
is
bl
pu
be T
Fig. 2.5
re
So, you can see geometrically that a quadratic polynomial can have either two
distinct zeroes or two equal zeroes (i.e., one zero), or no zero. This also means that a
tt E
polynomial to be? Let us find out. Consider the cubic polynomial x3 – 4x. To see what
the graph of y = x3 – 4x looks like, let us list a few values of y corresponding to a few
values for x as shown in Table 2.2.
no N
Table 2.2
x –2 –1 0 1 2
©
y = x3 – 4x 0 3 0 –3 0
Locating the points of the table on a graph paper and drawing the graph, we see
that the graph of y = x3 – 4x actually looks like the one given in Fig. 2.6.
d
x -coordinates of the only points
where the graph of y = x3 – 4x
he
intersects the x -axis. Since the curve
meets the x - axis in only these 3
points, their x -coordinates are the
is
only zeroes of the polynomial.
Let us take a few more
examples. Consider the cubic
bl
polynomials x3 and x3 – x2. We draw
the graphs of y = x3 and y = x3 – x2
pu
in Fig. 2.7 and Fig. 2.8 respectively.
Fig. 2.6
be T
re
o R
tt E
C
no N
©
Note that 0 is the only zero of the polynomial x3. Also, from Fig. 2.7, you can see
that 0 is the x - coordinate of the only point where the graph of y = x3 intersects the
x -axis. Similarly, since x3 – x2 = x2 (x – 1), 0 and 1 are the only zeroes of the polynomial
x3 – x2 . Also, from Fig. 2.8, these values are the x - coordinates of the only points
d
where the graph of y = x3 – x2 intersects the x-axis.
From the examples above, we see that there are at most 3 zeroes for any cubic
he
polynomial. In other words, any polynomial of degree 3 can have at most three zeroes.
Remark : In general, given a polynomial p(x) of degree n, the graph of y = p(x)
intersects the x- axis at atmost n points. Therefore, a polynomial p(x) of degree n has
at most n zeroes.
is
Example 1 : Look at the graphs in Fig. 2.9 given below. Each is the graph of y = p(x),
where p(x) is a polynomial. For each of the graphs, find the number of zeroes of p(x).
bl
pu
be T
re
o R
tt E
C
no N
Fig. 2.9
©
Solution :
(i) The number of zeroes is 1 as the graph intersects the x- axis at one point only.
(ii) The number of zeroes is 2 as the graph intersects the x -axis at two points.
(iii) The number of zeroes is 3. (Why?)
d
EXERCISE 2.1
he
1. The graphs of y = p(x) are given in Fig. 2.10 below, for some polynomials p(x). Find the
number of zeroes of p(x), in each case.
is
bl
pu
be T
re
o R
tt E
C
Fig. 2.10
You have already seen that zero of a linear polynomial ax + b is − b . We will now try
a
to answer the question raised in Section 2.1 regarding the relationship between zeroes
and coefficients of a quadratic polynomial. For this, let us take a quadratic polynomial,
©
say p(x) = 2x2 – 8x + 6. In Class IX, you have learnt how to factorise quadratic
polynomials by splitting the middle term. So, here we need to split the middle term
‘– 8x’ as a sum of two terms, whose product is 6 × 2x2 = 12x2. So, we write
2x2 – 8x + 6 = 2x2 – 6x – 2x + 6 = 2x(x – 3) – 2(x – 3)
= (2x – 2)(x – 3) = 2(x – 1)(x – 3)
− (−8) −(Coefficient of x)
Sum of its zeroes = 1+ 3 = 4 =
=
Coefficient of x 2
d
2
6 Constant term
Product of its zeroes = 1 × 3 = 3 = =
he
2 Coefficient of x 2
Let us take one more quadratic polynomial, say, p(x) = 3x2 + 5x – 2. By the
method of splitting the middle term,
3x2 + 5x – 2 = 3x2 + 6x – x – 2 = 3x(x + 2) –1(x + 2)
is
= (3x – 1)(x + 2)
Hence, the value of 3x2 + 5x – 2 is zero when either 3x – 1 = 0 or x + 2 = 0, i.e.,
bl
1 1
when x = or x = –2. So, the zeroes of 3x2 + 5x – 2 are and – 2. Observe that :
3 3
pu
1 − 5 − (Coefficient of x)
Sum of its zeroes = + ( − 2) = =
3 3 Coefficient of x 2
be T
1 −2 Constant term
× ( − 2) = =
re
Product of its zeroes =
3 3 Coefficient of x 2
o R
In general, if α* and β* are the zeroes of the quadratic polynomial p(x) = ax2 + bx + c,
a ≠ 0, then you know that x – α and x – β are the factors of p(x). Therefore,
tt E
c
αβ =
a
* α,β are Greek letters pronounced as ‘alpha’ and ‘beta’ respectively. We will use later one
more letter ‘γ’ pronounced as ‘gamma’.
b − (Coefficient of x)
i.e., sum of zeroes = α + β = − = ,
a Coefficient of x2
d
c Constant term
product of zeroes = αβ = = .
a Coefficient of x2
he
Let us consider some examples.
Example 2 : Find the zeroes of the quadratic polynomial x2 + 7x + 10, and verify the
relationship between the zeroes and the coefficients.
is
Solution : We have
x2 + 7x + 10 = (x + 2)(x + 5)
bl
So, the value of x2 + 7x + 10 is zero when x + 2 = 0 or x + 5 = 0, i.e., when x = – 2 or
x = –5. Therefore, the zeroes of x2 + 7x + 10 are – 2 and – 5. Now,
−(7) – (Coefficient of x )
pu
sum of zeroes = – 2 + (– 5) = – (7) = = ,
1 Coefficient of x 2
be T
10 Constant term
product of zeroes = (− 2) × (− 5) = 10 = = ⋅
1 Coefficient of x2
re
o R
Example 3 : Find the zeroes of the polynomial x2 – 3 and verify the relationship
between the zeroes and the coefficients.
tt E
Solution : Recall the identity a 2 – b 2 = (a – b)(a + b). Using it, we can write:
(
x2 – 3 = x − 3 x + 3 )( )
C
− (Coefficient of x) ,
sum of zeroes = 3− 3= 0 =
Coefficient of x 2
Example 4 : Find a quadratic polynomial, the sum and product of whose zeroes are
– 3 and 2, respectively.
Solution : Let the quadratic polynomial be ax2 + bx + c, and its zeroes be α and β.
We have
d
−b ,
α+β= –3=
he
a
c.
and αβ = 2 =
a
is
If a = 1, then b = 3 and c = 2.
So, one quadratic polynomial which fits the given conditions is x2 + 3x + 2.
bl
You can check that any other quadratic polynomial that fits these conditions will
be of the form k(x2 + 3x + 2), where k is real.
Let us now look at cubic polynomials. Do you think a similar relation holds
pu
between the zeroes of a cubic polynomial and its coefficients?
Let us consider p(x) = 2x3 – 5x2 – 14x + 8.
be T
1
You can check that p(x) = 0 for x = 4, – 2, ⋅ Since p(x) can have atmost three
re
2
o R
2 2 2 Coefficient of x 3
1 −8 – Constant term
product of the zeroes = 4 × (−2) × = −4 = = .
C
2 2 Coefficient of x3
However, there is one more relationship here. Consider the sum of the products
no N
{4 × (− 2)} + ⎧⎨ (− 2) ×
1 ⎫ ⎧1 ⎫
⎬ + ⎨ × 4⎬
⎩ 2⎭ ⎩2 ⎭
©
−14 Coefficient of x
= – 8− 1+ 2 = −7 = = .
2 Coefficient of x3
In general, it can be proved that if α, β, γ are the zeroes of the cubic polynomial
ax + bx2 + cx + d, then
3
–b
α +β + γ =
,
a
c
αβ + βγ + γα = ,
a
d
–d
α β γ = .
a
he
Let us consider an example.
1
Example 5* : Verify that 3, –1, − are the zeroes of the cubic polynomial
is
3
p(x) = 3x3 – 5x2 – 11x – 3, and then verify the relationship between the zeroes and the
coefficients.
bl
Solution : Comparing the given polynomial with ax3 + bx 2 + cx + d, we get
a = 3, b = – 5, c = –11, d = – 3. Further
pu
p(3) = 3 × 33 – (5 × 32) – (11 × 3) – 3 = 81 – 45 – 33 – 3 = 0,
p(–1) = 3 × (–1)3 – 5 × (–1)2 – 11 × (–1) – 3 = –3 – 5 + 11 – 3 = 0,
be T
3 2
⎛ 1⎞ ⎛ 1⎞ ⎛ 1⎞ ⎛ 1⎞
p ⎜ − ⎟ = 3 × ⎜ − ⎟ − 5 × ⎜ − ⎟ − 11 × ⎜ − ⎟ − 3 ,
⎝ 3⎠ ⎝ 3⎠ ⎝ 3⎠ ⎝ 3⎠
re
o R
1 5 11 2 2
= – − + −3= – + =0
9 9 3 3 3
tt E
1
Therefore, 3, –1 and − are the zeroes of 3x3 – 5x2 – 11x – 3.
3
1
C
α + β + γ = 3 + ( −1) + ⎜ − ⎟ = 2 − = = =
⎝ ⎠3 3 3 3 a
⎛ 1⎞ ⎛ 1 ⎞ 1 −11 c ,
αβ + β γ +γ α = 3 × ( −1) + ( −1) × ⎜ − ⎟ + ⎜− ⎟× 3 = −3 + −1= =
⎝ 3⎠ ⎝ 3⎠
©
3 3 a
⎛ 1⎞ − ( −3) − d .
αβγ = 3 × ( −1) × ⎜ − ⎟ = 1 = =
⎝ 3⎠ 3 a
EXERCISE 2.2
1. Find the zeroes of the following quadratic polynomials and verify the relationship between
the zeroes and the coefficients.
(i) x2 – 2x – 8 (ii) 4s2 – 4s + 1 (iii) 6x 2 – 3 – 7x
d
(iv) 4u2 + 8u (v) t2 – 15 (vi) 3x 2 – x – 4
he
2. Find a quadratic polynomial each with the given numbers as the sum and product of its
zeroes respectively.
1, 1
(i) −1 (ii) 2 , (iii) 0, 5
4 3
is
1, 1
(iv) 1, 1 (v) − (vi) 4, 1
4 4
bl
You know that a cubic polynomial has at most three zeroes. However, if you are given
only one zero, can you find the other two? For this, let us consider the cubic polynomial
pu
x3 – 3x2 – x + 3. If we tell you that one of its zeroes is 1, then you know that x – 1 is
a factor of x3 – 3x2 – x + 3. So, you can divide x3 – 3x2 – x + 3 by x – 1, as you have
learnt in Class IX, to get the quotient x2 – 2x – 3.
be T
Next, you could get the factors of x2 – 2x – 3, by splitting the middle term, as
re
(x + 1)(x – 3). This would give you
o R
x3 – 3x2 – x + 3 = (x – 1)(x2 – 2x – 3)
= (x – 1)(x + 1)(x – 3)
tt E
So, all the three zeroes of the cubic polynomial are now known to you as
1, – 1, 3.
C
Let us discuss the method of dividing one polynomial by another in some detail.
Before noting the steps formally, consider an example.
no N
d
of their degrees. Recall that arranging the terms 2
in this order is called writing the polynomials in –5 x – x + 5
–5x2 – 10 x – 5
he
standard form. In this example, the dividend is
+ + +
already in standard form, and the divisor, in
9x + 10
standard form, is x2 + 2x + 1.
Step 1 : To obtain the first term of the quotient, divide the highest degree term of the
is
dividend (i.e., 3x3) by the highest degree term of the divisor (i.e., x2). This is 3x. Then
carry out the division process. What remains is – 5x2 – x + 5.
bl
Step 2 : Now, to obtain the second term of the quotient, divide the highest degree term
of the new dividend (i.e., –5x2) by the highest degree term of the divisor (i.e., x2). This
gives –5. Again carry out the division process with – 5x2 – x + 5.
pu
Step 3 : What remains is 9x + 10. Now, the degree of 9x + 10 is less than the degree
of the divisor x2 + 2x + 1. So, we cannot continue the division any further.
be T
= 3x3 + x2 + 2x + 5
Here again, we see that
tt E
If p(x) and g(x) are any two polynomials with g(x) ≠ 0, then we can find
polynomials q(x) and r(x) such that
p(x) = g(x) × q(x) + r(x),
©
d
So, dividend = –x3 + 3x 2 – 3x + 5 and 2
2 x – 2x + 5
divisor = –x2 + x – 1. 2
2x – 2 x + 2
he
– + –
Division process is shown on the right side.
3
We stop here since degree (3) = 0 < 2 = degree (–x2 + x – 1).
So, quotient = x – 2, remainder = 3.
is
Now,
Divisor × Quotient + Remainder
bl
= (–x2 + x – 1) (x – 2) + 3
= –x3 + x2 – x + 2x2 – 2x + 2 + 3
= –x3 + 3x2 – 3x + 5
pu
= Dividend
In this way, the division algorithm is verified.
be T
Example 9 : Find all the zeroes of 2x4 – 3x3 – 3x2 + 6x – 2, if you know that two of
re
o R
2x2 – 3 x + 1
2
x –2 4 3
2 x – 3x – 3 x + 6x – 2
2
2x4
First term of quotient is = 2x2
2 x4 – 4 x2 x2
no N
– +
3 2
– 3x + x + 6 x – 2 −3 x3
3 Second term of quotient is = − 3x
– 3x + 6x x2
©
+ –
2
x –2 x2
2 Third term of quotient is =1
x –2 x2
– +
0
Now, by splitting –3x, we factorise 2x2 – 3x + 1 as (2x – 1)(x – 1). So, its zeroes
1
are given by x = and x = 1. Therefore, the zeroes of the given polynomial are
d
2
1
2 , − 2, , and 1.
he
2
EXERCISE 2.3
is
1. Divide the polynomial p(x) by the polynomial g(x) and find the quotient and remainder
in each of the following :
(i) p(x) = x 3 – 3x2 + 5x – 3, g(x) = x 2 – 2
bl
(ii) p(x) = x 4 – 3x2 + 4x + 5, g(x) = x 2 + 1 – x
(iii) p(x) = x 4 – 5x + 6, g(x) = 2 – x2
pu
2. Check whether the first polynomial is a factor of the second polynomial by dividing the
second polynomial by the first polynomial:
(i) t2 – 3, 2t4 + 3t3 – 2t2 – 9t – 12
be T
(ii) x 2 + 3x + 1, 3x4 + 5x 3 – 7x 2 + 2x + 2
re
(iii) x 3 – 3x + 1, x 5 – 4x3 + x2 + 3x + 1
o R
5 5
and – ⋅
3. Obtain all other zeroes of 3x4 + 6x 3 – 2x 2 – 10x – 5, if two of its zeroes are
3 3
4. On dividing x3 – 3x 2 + x + 2 by a polynomial g(x), the quotient and remainder were x – 2
tt E
and
(i) deg p(x) = deg q(x) (ii) deg q(x) = deg r(x) (iii) deg r(x) = 0
no N
1,
(i) 2x3 + x2 – 5x + 2; 1, – 2 (ii) x3 – 4x 2 + 5x – 2; 2, 1, 1
2
2. Find a cubic polynomial with the sum, sum of the product of its zeroes taken two at a
time, and the product of its zeroes as 2, –7, –14 respectively.
*These exercises are not from the examination point of view.
4. If two zeroes of the polynomial x4 – 6x3 – 26x2 + 138x – 35 are 2 ± 3 , find other zeroes.
d
the remainder comes out to be x + a, find k and a.
2.5 Summary
he
In this chapter, you have studied the following points:
1. Polynomials of degrees 1, 2 and 3 are called linear, quadratic and cubic polynomials
respectively.
2. A quadratic polynomial in x with real coefficients is of the form ax 2 + bx + c, where a, b, c
is
are real numbers with a ≠ 0.
3. The zeroes of a polynomial p(x) are precisely the x-coordinates of the points, where the
bl
graph of y = p(x) intersects the x -axis.
4. A quadratic polynomial can have at most 2 zeroes and a cubic polynomial can have
at most 3 zeroes.
pu
5. If α and β are the zeroes of the quadratic polynomial ax2 + bx + c, then
b c
α +β = − , αβ =
be T
.
a a
re
6. If α, β, γ are the zeroes of the cubic polynomial ax3 + bx2 + cx + d, then
o R
−b ,
α +β + γ =
a
tt E
c,
αβ + β γ + γ α =
a
C
−d .
and αβ γ =
a
no N
7. The division algorithm states that given any polynomial p(x) and any non-zero
polynomial g(x), there are polynomials q(x) and r(x) such that
p(x) = g(x) q(x) + r(x),
©
In fact, this is true for any linear equation, that is, each solution (x, y) of a
linear equation in two variables, ax + by + c = 0, corresponds to a point on the
line representing the equation, and vice versa.
Now, consider Equations (1) and (2) given above. These equations, taken
together, represent the information we have about Akhila at the fair.
These two linear equations are in the same two variables x and y. Equations
like these are called a pair of linear equations in two variables.
Let us see what such pairs look like algebraically.
The general form for a pair of linear equations in two variables x and y is
a1 x + b1 y + c1 = 0
and a2 x + b2 y + c2 = 0,
where a1, b1, c1, a2, b2, c2 are all real numbers and a12 + b12 ≠ 0, a22 + b22 ≠ 0.
Some examples of pair of linear equations in two variables are:
2x + 3y – 7 = 0 and 9x – 2y + 8 = 0
5x = y and –7x + 2y + 3 = 0
x + y = 7 and 17 = y
Do you know, what do they look like geometrically?
Recall, that you have studied in Class IX that the geometrical (i.e., graphical)
representation of a linear equation in two variables is a straight line. Can you now
suggest what a pair of linear equations in two variables will look like, geometrically?
There will be two straight lines, both to be considered together.
You have also studied in Class IX that given two lines in a plane, only one of the
following three possibilities can happen:
(i) The two lines will intersect at one point.
(ii) The two lines will not intersect, i.e., they are parallel.
(iii) The two lines will be coincident.
Fig. 3.1
Both ways of representing a pair of linear equations go hand-in-hand — the
algebraic and the geometric ways. Let us consider some examples.
Example 1 : Let us take the example given in Section 3.1. Akhila goes to a fair with
Rs 20 and wants to have rides on the Giant Wheel and play Hoopla. Represent this
situation algebraically and graphically (geometrically).
Solution : The pair of equations formed is :
1
y= x
2
i.e., x – 2y = 0 (1)
3x + 4y = 20 (2)
Let us represent these equations graphically. For this, we need at least two
solutions for each equation. We give these solutions in Table 3.1.
Table 3.1
20
x 0 2 x 0 4
3
x 20 3x
y= 0 1 y= 5 0 2
2 4
(i) (ii)
Recall from Class IX that there are infinitely many solutions of each linear
equation. So each of you can choose any two values, which may not be the ones we
have chosen. Can you guess why we have chosen x = 0 in the first equation and in the
second equation? When one of the variables is zero, the equation reduces to a linear
42 MATHEMATICS
equation in one variable, which can be solved easily. For instance, putting x = 0 in
Equation (2), we get 4y = 20, i.e., y = 5. Similarly, putting y = 0 in Equation (2), we get
20 20
3x = 20, i.e., x = . But as is
3 3
not an integer, it will not be easy to
plot exactly on the graph paper. So,
we choose y = 2 which gives x = 4,
an integral value.
Example 2 : Romila went to a stationery shop and purchased 2 pencils and 3 erasers
for ` 9. Her friend Sonali saw the new variety of pencils and erasers with Romila, and
she also bought 4 pencils and 6 erasers of the same kind for ` 18. Represent this
situation algebraically and graphically.
Solution : Let us denote the cost of 1 pencil by ` x and one eraser by ` y. Then the
algebraic representation is given by the following equations:
2x + 3y = 9 (1)
4x + 6y = 18 (2)
To obtain the equivalent geometric representation, we find two points on the line
representing each equation. That is, we find two solutions of each equation.
PAIR OF LINEAR EQUATIONS IN TWO VARIABLES 43
9 2x 18 4 x
y= 3 0 y= 3 1
3 6
(i) (ii)
We plot these points in a graph
paper and draw the lines. We find that
both the lines coincide (see Fig. 3.3).
This is so, because, both the
equations are equivalent, i.e., one can
be derived from the other.
x 0 4 x 0 6
4x 12 2 x
y= 2 0 y= 3 0
2 4
(i) (ii)
To represent the equations graphically, we plot the points R(0, 2) and S(4, 0), to
get the line RS and the points P(0, 3) and Q(6, 0) to get the line PQ.
44 MATHEMATICS
In the situation of Example 1, find out how many rides on the Giant Wheel
Akhila had, and how many times she played Hoopla.
In Fig. 3.2, you noted that the equations representing the situation are
geometrically shown by two lines intersecting at the point (4, 2). Therefore, the
PAIR OF LINEAR EQUATIONS IN TWO VARIABLES 45
point (4, 2) lies on the lines represented by both the equations x – 2y = 0 and
3x + 4y = 20. And this is the only common point.
Let us verify algebraically that x = 4, y = 2 is a solution of the given
pair of equations. Substituting the values of x and y in each equation, we get
4 – 2 × 2 = 0 and 3(4) + 4(2) = 20. So, we have verified that x = 4, y = 2 is a
solution of both the equations. Since (4, 2) is the only common point on both
the lines, there is one and only one solution for this pair of linear equations
in two variables.
Thus, the number of rides Akhila had on Giant Wheel is 4 and the number
of times she played Hoopla is 2.
In the situation of Example 2, can you find the cost of each pencil and each
eraser?
In Fig. 3.3, the situation is geometrically shown by a pair of coincident
lines. The solutions of the equations are given by the common points.
Are there any common points on these lines? From the graph, we observe
that every point on the line is a common solution to both the equations. So, the
equations 2x + 3y = 9 and 4x + 6y = 18 have infinitely many solutions. This
should not surprise us, because if we divide the equation 4x + 6y = 18 by 2 , we
get 2x + 3y = 9, which is the same as Equation (1). That is, both the equations are
equivalent. From the graph, we see that any point on the line gives us a possible
cost of each pencil and eraser. For instance, each pencil and eraser can cost
` 3 and ` 1 respectively. Or, each pencil can cost ` 3.75 and eraser can cost
` 0.50, and so on.
In the situation of Example 3, can the two rails cross each other?
In Fig. 3.4, the situation is represented geometrically by two parallel lines.
Since the lines do not intersect at all, the rails do not cross. This also means that
the equations have no common solution.
A pair of linear equations which has no solution, is called an inconsistent pair of
linear equations. A pair of linear equations in two variables, which has a solution, is
called a consistent pair of linear equations. A pair of linear equations which are
equivalent has infinitely many distinct common solutions. Such a pair is called a
dependent pair of linear equations in two variables. Note that a dependent pair of
linear equations is always consistent.
We can now summarise the behaviour of lines representing a pair of linear equations
in two variables and the existence of solutions as follows:
46 MATHEMATICS
(i) the lines may intersect in a single point. In this case, the pair of equations
has a unique solution (consistent pair of equations).
(ii) the lines may be parallel. In this case, the equations have no solution
(inconsistent pair of equations).
(iii) the lines may be coincident. In this case, the equations have infinitely many
solutions [dependent (consistent) pair of equations].
Let us now go back to the pairs of linear equations formed in Examples 1, 2, and
3, and note down what kind of pair they are geometrically.
(i) x – 2y = 0 and 3x + 4y – 20 = 0 (The lines intersect)
(ii) 2x + 3y – 9 = 0 and 4x + 6y – 18 = 0 (The lines coincide)
(iii) x + 2y – 4 = 0 and 2x + 4y – 12 = 0 (The lines are parallel)
a1 , b1 c
Let us now write down, and compare, the values of and 1 in all the
a2 b2 c2
three examples. Here, a1, b1, c1 and a2, b2, c2 denote the coefficents of equations
given in the general form in Section 3.2.
Table 3.4
a1 b1 c1
Sl Pair of lines Compare the Graphical Algebraic
a2 b2 c2
No. ratios representation interpretation
1 2 0 a1 b
1
1. x – 2y = 0 Intersecting Exactly one
3 4 20 a2 b2
lines solution
3x + 4y – 20 = 0
(unique)
2 3 9 a1 b1 c
2. 2x + 3y – 9 = 0 1 Coincident Infinitely
4 6 18 a2 b2 c2
lines many solutions
4x + 6y – 18 = 0
1 2 4 a1 b1
c
1 Parallel lines No solution
3. x + 2y – 4 = 0
2 4 12 a2 b2 c2
2x + 4y – 12 = 0
From the table above, you can observe that if the lines represented by the equation
a1x + b1y + c1 = 0
and a2x + b2y + c2 = 0
PAIR OF LINEAR EQUATIONS IN TWO VARIABLES 47
a1 b1
are (i) intersecting, then
a2 b2
a b c
(ii) coincident, then 1 1 1
a2 b2 c2
a1 b1 c1
(iii) parallel, then
a2 b2 c2
In fact, the converse is also true for any pair of lines. You can verify them by
considering some more examples by yourself.
Let us now consider some more examples to illustrate it.
Table 3.5
x 0 6 x 0 3
6x 2 x 12
y= 2 0 y= –4 –2
3 3
Example 5 : Graphically, find whether the following pair of equations has no solution,
unique solution or infinitely many solutions:
5x – 8y + 1 = 0 (1)
24 3
3x – y + = 0 (2)
5 5
5
Solution : Multiplying Equation (2) by , we get
3
5x – 8y + 1 = 0
But, this is the same as Equation (1). Hence the lines represented by Equations (1)
and (2) are coincident. Therefore, Equations (1) and (2) have infinitely many solutions.
Plot few points on the graph and verify it yourself.
Example 6 : Champa went to a ‘Sale’ to purchase some pants and skirts. When her
friends asked her how many of each she had bought, she answered, “The number of
skirts is two less than twice the number of pants purchased. Also, the number of skirts
is four less than four times the number of pants purchased”. Help her friends to find
how many pants and skirts Champa bought.
Solution : Let us denote the number of pants by x and the number of skirts by y. Then
the equations formed are :
y = 2x – 2 (1)
and y = 4x – 4 (2)
Table 3.6
x 2 0
y = 2x – 2 2 –2
x 0 1
y = 4x – 4 –4 0
Fig. 3.6
PAIR OF LINEAR EQUATIONS IN TWO VARIABLES 49
Plot the points and draw the lines passing through them to represent the equations,
as shown in Fig. 3.6.
The two lines intersect at the point (1, 0). So, x = 1, y = 0 is the required solution
of the pair of linear equations, i.e., the number of pants she purchased is 1 and she did
not buy any skirt.
Verify the answer by checking whether it satisfies the conditions of the given
problem.
EXERCISE 3.2
1. Form the pair of linear equations in the following problems, and find their solutions
graphically.
(i) 10 students of Class X took part in a Mathematics quiz. If the number of girls is 4
more than the number of boys, find the number of boys and girls who took part in
the quiz.
(ii) 5 pencils and 7 pens together cost ` 50, whereas 7 pencils and 5 pens together
cost ` 46. Find the cost of one pencil and that of one pen.
a1 , b1 c
2. On comparing the ratios and 1 , find out whether the lines representing the
a2 b2 c2
following pairs of linear equations intersect at a point, are parallel or coincident:
(i) 5x – 4y + 8 = 0 (ii) 9x + 3y + 12 = 0
7x + 6y – 9 = 0 18x + 6y + 24 = 0
(iii) 6x – 3y + 10 = 0
2x – y + 9 = 0
a1 , b1 c
3. On comparing the ratios and 1 , find out whether the following pair of linear
a2 b 2 c2
equations are consistent, or inconsistent.
(i) 3x + 2y = 5 ; 2x – 3y = 7 (ii) 2x – 3y = 8 ; 4x – 6y = 9
3 5
(iii) x y 7 ; 9x – 10y = 14 (iv) 5x – 3y = 11 ; – 10x + 6y = –22
2 3
4
(v) x 2 y 8 ; 2x + 3y = 12
3
4. Which of the following pairs of linear equations are consistent/inconsistent? If
consistent, obtain the solution graphically:
50 MATHEMATICS
(i) x + y = 5, 2x + 2y = 10
(ii) x – y = 8, 3x – 3y = 16
(iii) 2x + y – 6 = 0, 4x – 2y – 4 = 0
(iv) 2x – 2y – 2 = 0, 4x – 4y – 5 = 0
5. Half the perimeter of a rectangular garden, whose length is 4 m more than its width, is
36 m. Find the dimensions of the garden.
6. Given the linear equation 2x + 3y – 8 = 0, write another linear equation in two variables
such that the geometrical representation of the pair so formed is:
(i) intersecting lines (ii) parallel lines
(iii) coincident lines
7. Draw the graphs of the equations x – y + 1 = 0 and 3x + 2y – 12 = 0. Determine the
coordinates of the vertices of the triangle formed by these lines and the x-axis, and
shade the triangular region.
4, 1
(–1.75, 3.3), , etc. There is every possibility of making mistakes while reading
13 19
such coordinates. Is there any alternative method of finding the solution? There are
several algebraic methods, which we shall now discuss.
19 49
x = 3 – 2 =
29 29
49 19
Therefore, the solution is x = ,y= .
29 29
49 19
Verification : Substituting x = and y = , you can verify that both the Equations
29 29
(1) and (2) are satisfied.
To understand the substitution method more clearly, let us consider it stepwise:
Step 1 : Find the value of one variable, say y in terms of the other variable, i.e., x from
either equation, whichever is convenient.
Step 2 : Substitute this value of y in the other equation, and reduce it to an equation in
one variable, i.e., in terms of x, which can be solved. Sometimes, as in Examples 9 and
10 below, you can get statements with no variable. If this statement is true, you can
conclude that the pair of linear equations has infinitely many solutions. If the statement
is false, then the pair of linear equations is inconsistent.
Step 3 : Substitute the value of x (or y) obtained in Step 2 in the equation used in
Step 1 to obtain the value of the other variable.
Example 9 : Let us consider Example 2 in Section 3.3, i.e., the cost of 2 pencils and
3 erasers is ` 9 and the cost of 4 pencils and 6 erasers is ` 18. Find the cost of each
pencil and each eraser.
Solution : The pair of linear equations formed were:
2x + 3y = 9 (1)
4x + 6y = 18 (2)
We first express the value of x in terms of y from the equation 2x + 3y = 9, to get
9 3y
x= (3)
2
Now we substitute this value of x in Equation (2), to get
4(9 3 y )
+ 6y = 18
2
i.e., 18 – 6y + 6y = 18
i.e., 18 = 18
This statement is true for all values of y. However, we do not get a specific value
of y as a solution. Therefore, we cannot obtain a specific value of x. This situation has
arisen bcause both the given equations are the same. Therefore, Equations (1) and (2)
have infinitely many solutions. Observe that we have obtained the same solution
graphically also. (Refer to Fig. 3.3, Section 3.2.) We cannot find a unique cost of a
pencil and an eraser, because there are many common solutions, to the given situation.
Example 10 : Let us consider the Example 3 of Section 3.2. Will the rails cross each
other?
PAIR OF LINEAR EQUATIONS IN TWO VARIABLES 53
EXERCISE 3.3
1. Solve the following pair of linear equations by the substitution method.
(i) x + y = 14 (ii) s – t = 3
s t
x–y=4 6
3 2
(iii) 3x – y = 3 (iv) 0.2x + 0.3y = 1.3
9x – 3y = 9 0.4x + 0.5y = 2.3
3x 5 y
(v) 2 x 3 y 0 (vi) 2
2 3
x y 13
3x 8y 0
3 2 6
2. Solve 2x + 3y = 11 and 2x – 4y = – 24 and hence find the value of ‘m’ for which
y = mx + 3.
3. Form the pair of linear equations for the following problems and find their solution by
substitution method.
(i) The difference between two numbers is 26 and one number is three times the other.
Find them.
(ii) The larger of two supplementary angles exceeds the smaller by 18 degrees. Find
them.
(iii) The coach of a cricket team buys 7 bats and 6 balls for ` 3800. Later, she buys 3
bats and 5 balls for ` 1750. Find the cost of each bat and each ball.
54 MATHEMATICS
(iv) The taxi charges in a city consist of a fixed charge together with the charge for the
distance covered. For a distance of 10 km, the charge paid is ` 105 and for a
journey of 15 km, the charge paid is ` 155. What are the fixed charges and the
charge per km? How much does a person have to pay for travelling a distance of
25 km?
9
(v) A fraction becomes , if 2 is added to both the numerator and the denominator.
11 5
If, 3 is added to both the numerator and the denominator it becomes . Find the
6
fraction.
(vi) Five years hence, the age of Jacob will be three times that of his son. Five years
ago, Jacob’s age was seven times that of his son. What are their present ages?
Example 11 : The ratio of incomes of two persons is 9 : 7 and the ratio of their
expenditures is 4 : 3. If each of them manages to save ` 2000 per month, find their
monthly incomes.
Solution : Let us denote the incomes of the two person by ` 9x and ` 7x and their
expenditures by ` 4y and ` 3y respectively. Then the equations formed in the situation
is given by :
9x – 4y = 2000 (1)
and 7x – 3y = 2000 (2)
Step 1 : Multiply Equation (1) by 3 and Equation (2) by 4 to make the coefficients of
y equal. Then we get the equations:
27x – 12y = 6000 (3)
28x – 12y = 8000 (4)
Step 2 : Subtract Equation (3) from Equation (4) to eliminate y, because the coefficients
of y are the same. So, we get
(28x – 27x) – (12y – 12y) = 8000 – 6000
i.e., x = 2000
Step 3 : Substituting this value of x in (1), we get
9(2000) – 4y = 2000
i.e., y = 4000
PAIR OF LINEAR EQUATIONS IN TWO VARIABLES 55
So, the solution of the equations is x = 2000, y = 4000. Therefore, the monthly incomes
of the persons are ` 18,000 and ` 14,000, respectively.
Remarks :
1. The method used in solving the example above is called the elimination method,
because we eliminate one variable first, to get a linear equation in one variable.
In the example above, we eliminated y. We could also have eliminated x. Try
doing it that way.
2. You could also have used the substitution, or graphical method, to solve this
problem. Try doing so, and see which method is more convenient.
Let us now note down these steps in the elimination method :
Step 1 : First multiply both the equations by some suitable non-zero constants to make
the coefficients of one variable (either x or y) numerically equal.
Step 2 : Then add or subtract one equation from the other so that one variable gets
eliminated. If you get an equation in one variable, go to Step 3.
If in Step 2, we obtain a true statement involving no variable, then the original
pair of equations has infinitely many solutions.
If in Step 2, we obtain a false statement involving no variable, then the original
pair of equations has no solution, i.e., it is inconsistent.
Step 3 : Solve the equation in one variable (x or y) so obtained to get its value.
Step 4 : Substitute this value of x (or y) in either of the original equations to get the
value of the other variable.
Now to illustrate it, we shall solve few more examples.
Example 12 : Use elimination method to find all possible solutions of the following
pair of linear equations :
2x + 3y = 8 (1)
4x + 6y = 7 (2)
Solution :
Example 13 : The sum of a two-digit number and the number obtained by reversing
the digits is 66. If the digits of the number differ by 2, find the number. How many such
numbers are there?
Solution : Let the ten’s and the unit’s digits in the first number be x and y, respectively.
So, the first number may be written as 10 x + y in the expanded form (for example,
56 = 10(5) + 6).
When the digits are reversed, x becomes the unit’s digit and y becomes the ten’s
digit. This number, in the expanded notation is 10y + x (for example, when 56 is
reversed, we get 65 = 10(6) + 5).
According to the given condition.
(10x + y) + (10y + x) = 66
i.e., 11(x + y) = 66
i.e., x+y= 6 (1)
We are also given that the digits differ by 2, therefore,
either x–y= 2 (2)
or y–x= 2 (3)
If x – y = 2, then solving (1) and (2) by elimination, we get x = 4 and y = 2.
In this case, we get the number 42.
If y – x = 2, then solving (1) and (3) by elimination, we get x = 2 and y = 4.
In this case, we get the number 24.
Thus, there are two such numbers 42 and 24.
Verification : Here 42 + 24 = 66 and 4 – 2 = 2. Also 24 + 42 = 66 and 4 – 2 = 2.
EXERCISE 3.4
1. Solve the following pair of linear equations by the elimination method and the substitution
method :
(i) x + y = 5 and 2x – 3y = 4 (ii) 3x + 4y = 10 and 2x – 2y = 2
x 2y y
(iii) 3x – 5y – 4 = 0 and 9x = 2y + 7 (iv) 1 and x 3
2 3 3
PAIR OF LINEAR EQUATIONS IN TWO VARIABLES 57
2. Form the pair of linear equations in the following problems, and find their solutions
(if they exist) by the elimination method :
(i) If we add 1 to the numerator and subtract 1 from the denominator, a fraction reduces
1
to 1. It becomes if we only add 1 to the denominator. What is the fraction?
2
(ii) Five years ago, Nuri was thrice as old as Sonu. Ten years later, Nuri will be twice as
old as Sonu. How old are Nuri and Sonu?
(iii) The sum of the digits of a two-digit number is 9. Also, nine times this number is
twice the number obtained by reversing the order of the digits. Find the number.
(iv) Meena went to a bank to withdraw ` 2000. She asked the cashier to give her
` 50 and ` 100 notes only. Meena got 25 notes in all. Find how many notes of
` 50 and ` 100 she received.
(v) A lending library has a fixed charge for the first three days and an additional charge
for each day thereafter. Saritha paid ` 27 for a book kept for seven days, while Susy
paid ` 21 for the book she kept for five days. Find the fixed charge and the charge
for each extra day.
The cost of 5 oranges and 3 apples is ` 35 and the cost of 2 oranges and 4 apples
is ` 28. Let us find the cost of an orange and an apple.
Let us denote the cost of an orange by ` x and the cost of an apple by ` y. Then,
the equations formed are :
5x + 3y = 35, i.e., 5x + 3y – 35 = 0 (1)
2x + 4y = 28, i.e., 2x + 4y – 28 = 0 (2)
Let us use the elimination method to solve these equations.
Multiply Equation (1) by 4 and Equation (2) by 3. We get
(4)(5)x + (4)(3)y + (4)(–35) = 0 (3)
(3)(2)x + (3)(4)y + (3)(–28) = 0 (4)
Subtracting Equation (4) from Equation (3), we get
[(5)(4) – (3)(2)]x + [(4)(3) – (3)(4)]y + [4(–35) – (3)(–28)] = 0
58 MATHEMATICS
– (4)(–35) (3)(28)
Therefore, x=
(5)(4) (3)(2)
c1a2 c2 a1
Similarly, you can get y=
a1b2 a2 b1
By simplyfing Equation (5), we get
84 140
x= =4
20 6
(35)(2) (5)(28) 70 140
Similarly, y= = =5
20 6 14
Therefore, x = 4, y = 5 is the solution of the given pair of equations.
Then, the cost of an orange is ` 4 and that of an apple is ` 5.
c1a2 c2 a1
y= (6)
a1b2 a2 b1
Now, two cases arise :
a b
Case 1 : a1b2 – a2b1 ≠ 0. In this case 1 1 . Then the pair of linear equations has
a2 b2
a unique solution.
a b
Case 2 : a1b2 – a2b1 = 0. If we write 1 1 k , then a1 = k a2, b1 = k b2.
a2 b2
Substituting the values of a1 and b1 in the Equation (1), we get
k (a2 x + b2 y) + c1 = 0. (7)
It can be observed that the Equations (7) and (2) can both be satisfied only if
c1
c1 = k c2, i.e., k.
c2
If c1 = k c2, any solution of Equation (2) will satisfy the Equation (1), and vice
a1 b1 c1
versa. So, if k , then there are infinitely many solutions to the pair of
a2 b2 c2
linear equations given by (1) and (2).
If c1 ≠ k c2, then any solution of Equation (1) will not satisfy Equation (2) and vice
versa. Therefore the pair has no solution.
We can summarise the discussion above for the pair of linear equations given by
(1) and (2) as follows:
a1 b1
(i) When , we get a unique solution.
a2 b2
a1 b1 c1
(ii) When , there are infinitely many solutions.
a2 b2 c2
a1 b1 c1
(iii) When , there is no solution.
a2 b2 c2
60 MATHEMATICS
Note that you can write the solution given by Equations (5) and (6) in the
following form :
x y 1
(8)
b1c2 b2c1 c1a2 c2 a1 a1b2 a2b1
In remembering the above result, the following diagram may be helpful to
you :
x y 1
b1 c1 a1 b1
b2 c2 a2 b2
The arrows between the two numbers indicate that they are to be multiplied and
the second product is to be subtracted from the first.
For solving a pair of linear equations by this method, we will follow the following
steps :
Step 1 : Write the given equations in the form (1) and (2).
Step 2 : Taking the help of the diagram above, write Equations as given in (8).
Step 3 : Find x and y, provided a1b2 – a2b1 ≠ 0
Step 2 above gives you an indication of why this method is called the
cross-multiplication method.
5 – 74 3 5
PAIR OF LINEAR EQUATIONS IN TWO VARIABLES 61
x y 1
Then =
(3)(74) (5)(46) (46)(3) ( 74)(2) (2)(5) (3)(3)
x y 1
i.e., =
222 230 138 148 10 9
x y 1
i.e., =
8 10 1
x 1 y 1
i.e., = and =
8 1 10 1
i.e., x= 8 and y = 10
Hence, the fare from the bus stand in Bangalore to Malleswaram is ` 8 and the fare to
Yeshwanthpur is ` 10.
Verification : You can check from the problem that the solution we have got is correct.
Example 15 : For which values of p does the pair of equations given below has unique
solution?
4x + py + 8 = 0
2x + 2y + 2 = 0
Solution : Here a1 = 4, a2 = 2, b1 = p, b2 = 2.
a1 b
Now for the given pair to have a unique solution : ≠ 1
a2 b2
4 p
i.e., ≠
2 2
i.e., p≠ 4
Therefore, for all values of p, except 4, the given pair of equations will have a unique
solution.
Example 16 : For what values of k will the following pair of linear equations have
infinitely many solutions?
kx + 3y – (k – 3) = 0
12x + ky – k = 0
a1 k b 3 c k 3
Solution : Here, , 1 , 1
a2 12 b2 k c2 k
a1 b1 c1
For a pair of linear equations to have infinitely many solutions :
a2 b2 c2
62 MATHEMATICS
k 3 k 3
So, we need =
12 k k
k 3
or, =
12 k
which gives k2 = 36, i.e., k = ± 6.
3 k 3
Also, =
k k
gives 3k = k2 – 3k, i.e., 6k = k2, which means k = 0 or k = 6.
Therefore, the value of k, that satisfies both the conditions, is k = 6. For this value, the
pair of linear equations has infinitely many solutions.
EXERCISE 3.5
1. Which of the following pairs of linear equations has unique solution, no solution, or
infinitely many solutions. In case there is a unique solution, find it by using cross
multiplication method.
(i) x – 3y – 3 = 0 (ii) 2x + y = 5
3x – 9y – 2 = 0 3x + 2y = 8
(iii) 3x – 5y = 20 (iv) x – 3y – 7 = 0
6x – 10y = 40 3x – 3y – 15 = 0
2. (i) For which values of a and b does the following pair of linear equations have an
infinite number of solutions?
2x + 3y = 7
(a – b) x + (a + b) y = 3a + b – 2
(ii) For which value of k will the following pair of linear equations have no solution?
3x + y = 1
(2k – 1) x + (k – 1) y = 2k + 1
3. Solve the following pair of linear equations by the substitution and cross-multiplication
methods :
8x + 5y = 9
3x + 2y = 4
4. Form the pair of linear equations in the following problems and find their solutions (if
they exist) by any algebraic method :
PAIR OF LINEAR EQUATIONS IN TWO VARIABLES 63
(i) A part of monthly hostel charges is fixed and the remaining depends on the
number of days one has taken food in the mess. When a student A takes food for
20 days she has to pay ` 1000 as hostel charges whereas a student B, who takes
food for 26 days, pays ` 1180 as hostel charges. Find the fixed charges and the
cost of food per day.
1 1
(ii) A fraction becomes when 1 is subtracted from the numerator and it becomes
3 4
when 8 is added to its denominator. Find the fraction.
(iii) Yash scored 40 marks in a test, getting 3 marks for each right answer and losing 1
mark for each wrong answer. Had 4 marks been awarded for each correct answer
and 2 marks been deducted for each incorrect answer, then Yash would have
scored 50 marks. How many questions were there in the test?
(iv) Places A and B are 100 km apart on a highway. One car starts from A and another
from B at the same time. If the cars travel in the same direction at different speeds,
they meet in 5 hours. If they travel towards each other, they meet in 1 hour. What
are the speeds of the two cars?
(v) The area of a rectangle gets reduced by 9 square units, if its length is reduced by
5 units and breadth is increased by 3 units. If we increase the length by 3 units and
the breadth by 2 units, the area increases by 67 square units. Find the dimensions
of the rectangle.
1 1
5 – 4 = – 2 (2)
x y
64 MATHEMATICS
1 1
You know that p = and q =
x y
Substitute the values of p and q to get
1 1 1 1
2, i.e., x and 3, i.e., y .
x 2 y 3
1 1
Verification : By substituting x and y in the given equations, we find that
2 3
both the equations are satisfied.
1 1
Solution : Let us put x 1 p and y 2 q . Then the given equations
1 1
5 = 2 (1)
x 1 y 2
1 1
6 3 = 1 (2)
x 1 y 2
can be written as : 5p + q = 2 (3)
6p – 3q = 1 (4)
PAIR OF LINEAR EQUATIONS IN TWO VARIABLES 65
Equations (3) and (4) form a pair of linear equations in the general form. Now,
1 1
you can use any method to solve these equations. We get p = and q =
3 3
1
Now, substituting for p, we have
x 1
1 1
= ,
x 1 3
i.e., x – 1 = 3, i.e., x = 4.
1
Similarly, substituting for q, we get
y2
1 1
=
y 2 3
i.e., 3 = y – 2, i.e., y = 5
Hence, x = 4, y = 5 is the required solution of the given pair of equations.
Verification : Substitute x = 4 and y = 5 in (1) and (2) to check whether they are
satisfied.
Hence, the speed of the boat in still water is 8 km/h and the speed of the stream
is 3 km/h.
Verification : Verify that the solution satisfies the conditions of the problem.
EXERCISE 3.6
1. Solve the following pairs of equations by reducing them to a pair of linear equations:
1 1 2 3
(i) 2 x 3 y 2 (ii) 2
x y
1 1 13 4 9
1
3x 2 y 6 x y
4 5 1
(iii) 3 y 14 (iv) x 1 y 2 2
x
3 6 3
4 y 23 1
x x 1 y 2
7x 2y
(v) 5 (vi) 6x + 3y = 6xy
xy
8x 7 y
15 2x + 4y = 5xy
xy
10 2 1 1 3
(vii) 4 (viii)
x y x y 3x y 3x y 4
15 5 1 1 1
2
x y x y 2(3x y ) 2(3x y ) 8
2. Formulate the following problems as a pair of equations, and hence find their solutions:
(i) Ritu can row downstream 20 km in 2 hours, and upstream 4 km in 2 hours. Find her
speed of rowing in still water and the speed of the current.
(ii) 2 women and 5 men can together finish an embroidery work in 4 days, while 3
women and 6 men can finish it in 3 days. Find the time taken by 1 woman alone to
finish the work, and also that taken by 1 man alone.
(iii) Roohi travels 300 km to her home partly by train and partly by bus. She takes 4
hours if she travels 60 km by train and the remaining by bus. If she travels 100 km
by train and the remaining by bus, she takes 10 minutes longer. Find the speed of
the train and the bus separately.
68 MATHEMATICS
x y
(iii) 0 (iv) (a – b)x + (a + b) y = a2 – 2ab – b2
a b
ax + by = a2 + b2. (a + b)(x + y) = a2 + b2
(v) 152x – 378y = – 74
–378x + 152y = – 604
8. ABCD is a cyclic quadrilateral (see Fig. 3.7).
Find the angles of the cyclic quadrilateral.
Fig. 3.7
* These exercises are not from the examination point of view.
PAIR OF LINEAR EQUATIONS IN TWO VARIABLES 69
3.6 Summary
In this chapter, you have studied the following points:
1. Two linear equations in the same two variables are called a pair of linear equations in two
variables. The most general form of a pair of linear equations is
a1x + b1y + c1 = 0
a2x + b2y + c2 = 0
where a1, a2, b1, b2, c1, c2 are real numbers, such that a12 b12 0, a22 b22 0.
2. A pair of linear equations in two variables can be represented, and solved, by the:
(i) graphical method
(ii) algebraic method
3. Graphical Method :
The graph of a pair of linear equations in two variables is represented by two lines.
(i) If the lines intersect at a point, then that point gives the unique solution of the two
equations. In this case, the pair of equations is consistent.
(ii) If the lines coincide, then there are infinitely many solutions — each point on the
line being a solution. In this case, the pair of equations is dependent (consistent).
(iii) If the lines are parallel, then the pair of equations has no solution. In this case, the
pair of equations is inconsistent.
4. Algebraic Methods : We have discussed the following methods for finding the solution(s)
of a pair of linear equations :
(i) Substitution Method
(ii) Elimination Method
(iii) Cross-multiplication Method
5. If a pair of linear equations is given by a1x + b1y + c1 = 0 and a2x + b2y + c2 = 0, then the
following situations can arise :
a1 b1
(i) : In this case, the pair of linear equations is consistent.
a2 b1
a1 b1 c1
(ii) : In this case, the pair of linear equations is inconsistent.
a2 b2 c2
a1 b1 c1
(iii) : In this case, the pair of linear equations is dependent and consistent.
a2 b2 c2
6. There are several situations which can be mathematically represented by two equations
that are not linear to start with. But we alter them so that they are reduced to a pair of
linear equations.
70 MATHEMATICS
QUADRATIC EQUATIONS 4
4.1 Introduction
In Chapter 2, you have studied different types of polynomials. One type was the
quadratic polynomial of the form ax2 + bx + c, a ≠ 0. When we equate this polynomial
to zero, we get a quadratic equation. Quadratic equations come up when we deal with
many real-life situations. For instance, suppose a
charity trust decides to build a prayer hall having
a carpet area of 300 square metres with its length
one metre more than twice its breadth. What
should be the length and breadth of the hall?
Suppose the breadth of the hall is x metres. Then,
its length should be (2x + 1) metres. We can depict
this information pictorially as shown in Fig. 4.1. Fig. 4.1
Now, area of the hall = (2x + 1). x m 2 = (2x2 + x) m 2
So, 2x2 + x = 300 (Given)
2
Therefore, 2x + x – 300 = 0
So, the breadth of the hall should satisfy the equation 2x2 + x – 300 = 0 which is a
quadratic equation.
Many people believe that Babylonians were the first to solve quadratic equations.
For instance, they knew how to find two positive numbers with a given positive sum
and a given positive product, and this problem is equivalent to solving a quadratic
equation of the form x 2 – px + q = 0. Greek mathematician Euclid developed a
geometrical approach for finding out lengths which, in our present day terminology,
are solutions of quadratic equations. Solving of quadratic equations, in general form, is
often credited to ancient Indian mathematicians. In fact, Brahmagupta (A.D.598–665)
gave an explicit formula to solve a quadratic equation of the form ax2 + bx = c. Later,
QUADRATIC EQUATIONS 71
Sridharacharya (A.D. 1025) derived a formula, now known as the quadratic formula,
(as quoted by Bhaskara II) for solving a quadratic equation by the method of completing
the square. An Arab mathematician Al-Khwarizmi (about A.D. 800) also studied
quadratic equations of different types. Abraham bar Hiyya Ha-Nasi, in his book
‘Liber embadorum’ published in Europe in A.D. 1145 gave complete solutions of
different quadratic equations.
In this chapter, you will study quadratic equations, and various ways of finding
their roots. You will also see some applications of quadratic equations in daily life
situations.
Solution :
(i) LHS = (x – 2)2 + 1 = x2 – 4x + 4 + 1 = x2 – 4x + 5
EXERCISE 4.1
1. Check whether the following are quadratic equations :
(i) (x + 1)2 = 2(x – 3) (ii) x2 – 2x = (–2) (3 – x)
(iii) (x – 2)(x + 1) = (x – 1)(x + 3) (iv) (x – 3)(2x +1) = x(x + 5)
(v) (2x – 1)(x – 3) = (x + 5)(x – 1) (vi) x2 + 3x + 1 = ( x – 2) 2
(vii) (x + 2)3 = 2x (x2 – 1) (viii) x3 – 4x 2 – x + 1 = (x – 2)3
2. Represent the following situations in the form of quadratic equations :
(i) The area of a rectangular plot is 528 m2. The length of the plot (in metres) is one
more than twice its breadth. We need to find the length and breadth of the plot.
74 MATHEMATICS
(ii) The product of two consecutive positive integers is 306. We need to find the
integers.
(iii) Rohan’s mother is 26 years older than him. The product of their ages (in years)
3 years from now will be 360. We would like to find Rohan’s present age.
(iv) A train travels a distance of 480 km at a uniform speed. If the speed had been
8 km/h less, then it would have taken 3 hours more to cover the same distance. We
need to find the speed of the train.
the quadratic equation, or that α satisfies the quadratic equation. Note that the
zeroes of the quadratic polynomial ax2 + bx + c and the roots of the quadratic
equation ax2 + bx + c = 0 are the same.
You have observed, in Chapter 2, that a quadratic polynomial can have at most
two zeroes. So, any quadratic equation can have atmost two roots.
You have learnt in Class IX, how to factorise quadratic polynomials by splitting
their middle terms. We shall use this knowledge for finding the roots of a quadratic
equation. Let us see how.
Example 3 : Find the roots of the equation 2x2 – 5x + 3 = 0, by factorisation.
Solution : Let us first split the middle term – 5x as –2x –3x [because (–2x) × (–3x) =
6x2 = (2x2) × 3].
So, 2x2 – 5x + 3 = 2x2 – 2x – 3x + 3 = 2x (x – 1) –3(x – 1) = (2x – 3)(x – 1)
Now, 2x2 – 5x + 3 = 0 can be rewritten as (2x – 3)(x – 1) = 0.
So, the values of x for which 2x2 – 5x + 3 = 0 are the same for which (2x – 3)(x – 1) = 0,
i.e., either 2x – 3 = 0 or x – 1 = 0.
3
Now, 2x – 3 = 0 gives x and x – 1 = 0 gives x = 1.
2
3
So, x and x = 1 are the solutions of the equation.
2
3
In other words, 1 and are the roots of the equation 2x2 – 5x + 3 = 0.
2
Verify that these are the roots of the given equation.
QUADRATIC EQUATIONS 75
Solution : 3x 2 2 6 x 2 = 3x 2 6 x 6 x 2
= 3x 3x 2 2 3x 2
= 3x 2 3x 2
So, the roots of the equation are the values of x for which
3 x 2 3x 2 0
2
Now, 3 x 2 0 for x .
3
So, this root is repeated twice, one for each repeated factor 3x 2 .
2 2.
Therefore, the roots of 3x 2 2 6x 2 0 are ,
3 3
76 MATHEMATICS
Example 6 : Find the dimensions of the prayer hall discussed in Section 4.1.
Solution : In Section 4.1, we found that if the breadth of the hall is x m, then x
satisfies the equation 2x2 + x – 300 = 0. Applying the factorisation method, we write
this equation as
2x2 – 24x + 25x – 300 = 0
2x (x – 12) + 25 (x – 12) = 0
i.e., (x – 12)(2x + 25) = 0
So, the roots of the given equation are x = 12 or x = – 12.5. Since x is the breadth
of the hall, it cannot be negative.
Thus, the breadth of the hall is 12 m. Its length = 2x + 1 = 25 m.
EXERCISE 4.2
1. Find the roots of the following quadratic equations by factorisation:
Therefore, (x – 2)(x + 4) = 2x + 1
i.e., x2 + 2x – 8 = 2x + 1
i.e., x2 – 9 = 0
So, Sunita’s present age satisfies the quadratic equation x2 – 9 = 0.
We can write this as x2 = 9. Taking square roots, we get x = 3 or x = – 3. Since
the age is a positive number, x = 3.
So, Sunita’s present age is 3 years.
Now consider the quadratic equation (x + 2)2 – 9 = 0. To solve it, we can write
it as (x + 2)2 = 9. Taking square roots, we get x + 2 = 3 or x + 2 = – 3.
Therefore, x=1 or x = –5
So, the roots of the equation (x + 2) 2 – 9 = 0 are 1 and – 5.
In both the examples above, the term containing x is completely inside a square,
and we found the roots easily by taking the square roots. But, what happens if we are
asked to solve the equation x2 + 4x – 5 = 0? We would probably apply factorisation to
do so, unless we realise (somehow!) that x2 + 4x – 5 = (x + 2)2 – 9.
So, solving x2 + 4x – 5 = 0 is equivalent to solving (x + 2) 2 – 9 = 0, which we have
seen is very quick to do. In fact, we can convert any quadratic equation to the form
(x + a) 2 – b2 = 0 and then we can easily find its roots. Let us see if this is possible.
Look at Fig. 4.2.
In this figure, we can see how x2 + 4x is being converted to (x + 2) 2 – 4.
Fig. 4.2
78 MATHEMATICS
9x2 – 15x + 6 = 0
5
Now, 9x2 – 15x + 6 = (3 x) 2 2 3x 6
2
2 2
5 5 5
= (3 x) 2 3 x 6
2
2 2 2
2 2
5 25 5 1
= 3x 6 = 3x
2 4 2 4
QUADRATIC EQUATIONS 79
5 1 5 1
i.e., 3x – = or 3x =
2 2 2 2
5 1
(We can also write this as 3x , where ‘±’ denotes ‘plus minus’.)
2 2
5 1 5 1
Thus, 3x = or 3x
2 2 2 2
5 1 5 1
So, x= or x
6 6 6 6
4
Therefore, x = 1 or x =
6
2
i.e., x = 1 or x =
3
2.
Therefore, the roots of the given equation are 1 and
3
Remark : Another way of showing this process is as follows :
3 3 2 3 2 3 3
80 MATHEMATICS
2
5 2 25
= x
6 3 36
2 2 2
5 1 5 1
= x x
6 36 6 6
2 2
So, the solutions of 3x2 – 5x + 2 = 0 are the same as those of x 5 1 0 ,
6 6
5 1 5 1 5 1 2
which are x – = ± , i.e., x = = 1 and x = = .
6 6 6 6 6 6 3
Let us consider some examples to illustrate the above process.
Example 7 : Solve the equation given in Example 3 by the method of completing the
square.
5 3
Solution : The equation 2x2 – 5x + 3 = 0 is the same as x 2 x 0.
2 2
2 2 2
5 3 5 5 3 5 1
Now, x2 x = x = x
2 2 4 4 2 4 16
2
5 1
Therefore, 2x2 – 5x + 3 = 0 can be written as x 0 .
4 16
So, the roots of the equation 2x2 – 5x + 3 = 0 are exactly the same as those of
2 2 2
5 1 5 1 5 1
x 0 . Now, x =0 is the same as x
4 16 4 16 4 16
5 1
Therefore, x =
4 4
5 1
i.e., x=
4 4
5 1 5 1
i.e., x= or x
4 4 4 4
3
i.e., x= or x = 1
2
QUADRATIC EQUATIONS 81
3
Therefore, the solutions of the equations are x and 1.
2
Let us verify our solutions.
2
3 3 3
Putting x in 2x – 5x + 3 = 0, we get 2 – 5 3 0 , which is
2
2 2 2
correct. Similarly, you can verify that x = 1 also satisfies the given equation.
In Example 7, we divided the equation 2x2 – 5x + 3 = 0 throughout by 2 to get
5 3
x2 – x = 0 to make the first term a perfect square and then completed the
2 2
square. Instead, we can multiply throughout by 2 to make the first term as 4x2 = (2x) 2
and then complete the square.
This method is illustrated in the next example.
Example 8 : Find the roots of the equation 5x2 – 6x – 2 = 0 by the method of completing
the square.
Solution : Multiplying the equation throughout by 5, we get
25x2 – 30x – 10 = 0
This is the same as
(5x) 2 – 2 × (5x) × 3 + 3 2 – 32 – 10 = 0
i.e., (5x – 3)2 – 9 – 10 = 0
i.e., (5x – 3)2 – 19 = 0
i.e., (5x – 3)2 = 19
i.e., 5x – 3 = 19
i.e., 5x = 3 19
3 19
So, x=
5
3 19 3 19
Therefore, the roots are and .
5 5
3 19 3 19
Verify that the roots are and .
5 5
82 MATHEMATICS
2
3 9
i.e., 2x 5 = 0
4 16
2
3 71
i.e., 2x =0
4 16
71
2
3
i.e., 2 x = 0
4 6
2
3
But 2 x cannot be negative for any real value of x (Why?). So, there is
4
no real value of x satisfying the given equation. Therefore, the given equation has no
real roots.
Now, you have seen several examples of the use of the method of completing
the square. So, let us give this method in general.
Consider the quadratic equation ax2 + bx + c = 0 (a ≠ 0). Dividing throughout by
b c
a, we get x2 x 0
a a
2 2
b b c
This is the same as x 0
2a 2a a
b 2 4ac
2
b
i.e., x =0
2a 4a2
So, the roots of the given equation are the same as those of
b 2 4 ac b 2 4 ac
2 2
b b
x 0, i.e., those of x (1)
2a 4a 2 2a 4a 2
QUADRATIC EQUATIONS 83
x
b b 2 4 ac
=
2a 2a
b b 2 4 ac
Therefore, x=
2a
b b 2 4 ac b b 2 4 ac
So, the roots of ax2 + bx + c = 0 are and , if
2a 2a
b 2 – 4ac ≥ 0. If b 2 – 4ac < 0, the equation will have no real roots. (Why?)
– b ± b 2 – 4ac
ax2 + bx + c = 0 are given by
2a
This formula for finding the roots of a quadratic equation is known as the
quadratic formula.
Let us consider some examples for illustrating the use of the quadratic formula.
1 1 4(2)(528) 1 4225 1 65
x=
4 4 4
64 – 66
i.e., x= or x
4 4
33
i.e., x = 16 or x =
2
Since x cannot be negative, being a dimension, the breadth of the plot is
16 metres and hence, the length of the plot is 33m.
You should verify that these values satisfy the conditions of the problem.
84 MATHEMATICS
Example 11 : Find two consecutive odd positive integers, sum of whose squares
is 290.
Solution : Let the smaller of the two consecutive odd positive integers be x. Then, the
second integer will be x + 2. According to the question,
x2 + (x + 2)2 = 290
i.e., x2 + x2 + 4x + 4 = 290
i.e., 2x2 + 4x – 286 = 0
i.e., x2 + 2x – 143 = 0
which is a quadratic equation in x.
Using the quadratic formula, we get
2 4 572 2 576 2 24
x=
2 2 2
i.e., x = 11 or x = – 13
But x is given to be an odd positive integer. Therefore, x ≠ – 13, x = 11.
Thus, the two consecutive odd integers are 11 and 13.
Check : 112 + 13 2 = 121 + 169 = 290.
Example 12 : A rectangular park is to be designed whose breadth is 3 m less than its
length. Its area is to be 4 square metres more than the area of a park that has already
been made in the shape of an isosceles triangle with its base as the breadth of the
rectangular park and of altitude 12 m (see Fig. 4.3). Find its length and breadth.
Solution : Let the breadth of the rectangular park be x m.
So, its length = (x + 3) m.
Therefore, the area of the rectangular park = x(x + 3) m2 = (x2 + 3x) m 2.
Now, base of the isosceles triangle = x m.
1
Therefore, its area = × x × 12 = 6 x m2.
2
According to our requirements,
x2 + 3x = 6x + 4
i.e., x2 – 3x – 4 = 0
Using the quadratic formula, we get
Fig. 4.3
QUADRATIC EQUATIONS 85
3 25 3 5
x= = = 4 or – 1
2 2
But x ≠ – 1 (Why?). Therefore, x = 4.
So, the breadth of the park = 4m and its length will be 7m.
Verification : Area of rectangular park = 28 m2,
area of triangular park = 24 m2 = (28 – 4) m2
Example 13 : Find the roots of the following quadratic equations, if they exist, using
the quadratic formula:
5 1 5 1 2
Therefore, x = , i.e., x = 1 or x =
6 6 3
2
So, the roots are and 1.
3
Since the square of a real number cannot be negative, therefore b 2 4ac will
not have any real value.
So, b 2 – 4ac = 8 – 8 = 0
2 2 0 2 1 .
Therefore, x = 0 , i.e., x
4 2 2
1 1 .
So, the roots are ,
2 2
86 MATHEMATICS
1 1 1
(i) x 3, x 0 (ii) 3, x 0, 2
x x x 2
Solution :
1
(i) x 3 . Multiplying throughout by x, we get
x
x2 + 1 = 3x
i.e., x2 – 3x + 1 = 0, which is a quadratic equation.
Here, a = 1, b = – 3, c = 1
So, b 2 – 4ac = 9 – 4 = 5 > 0
3 5
Therefore, x= (Why?)
2
3 5 3 5
So, the roots are and .
2 2
1 1
(ii) 3, x 0, 2 .
x x2
(x – 2) – x = 3x (x – 2)
= 3x2 – 6x
6 12 6 2 3 3 3
Therefore, x= .
6 6 3
3 3 3 3
So, the roots are and .
3 3
QUADRATIC EQUATIONS 87
Example 15 : A motor boat whose speed is 18 km/h in still water takes 1 hour more
to go 24 km upstream than to return downstream to the same spot. Find the speed of
the stream.
Solution : Let the speed of the stream be x km/h.
Therefore, the speed of the boat upstream = (18 – x) km/h and the speed of the boat
downstream = (18 + x) km/h.
distance 24
The time taken to go upstream = hours.
speed 18 x
24
Similarly, the time taken to go downstream = hours.
18 x
According to the question,
24 24
= 1
18 x 18 x
EXERCISE 4.3
1. Find the roots of the following quadratic equations, if they exist, by the method of
completing the square:
(i) 2x2 – 7x + 3 = 0 (ii) 2x2 + x – 4 = 0
(iii) 4 x 2 4 3x 3 0 (iv) 2x2 + x + 4 = 0
2. Find the roots of the quadratic equations given in Q.1 above by applying the quadratic
formula.
88 MATHEMATICS
– b b2 4ac
x=
2a
b b 2 4 ac
If b 2 – 4ac > 0, we get two distinct real roots and
2a 2a
b b 2 4 ac
– .
2a 2a
QUADRATIC EQUATIONS 89
b b b
If b 2 – 4ac = 0, then x = 0 , i.e., x or –
2a 2a 2a
b
So, the roots of the equation ax2 + bx + c = 0 are both
2a
Therefore, we say that the quadratic equation ax 2 + bx + c = 0 has two equal
real roots in this case.
If b2 – 4ac < 0, then there is no real number whose square is b2 – 4ac. Therefore,
there are no real roots for the given quadratic equation in this case.
Since b2 – 4ac determines whether the quadratic equation ax2 + bx + c = 0 has
real roots or not, b 2 – 4ac is called the discriminant of this quadratic equation.
So, a quadratic equation ax2 + bx + c = 0 has
(i) two distinct real roots, if b 2 – 4ac > 0,
(ii) two equal real roots, if b2 – 4ac = 0,
(iii) no real roots, if b 2 – 4ac < 0.
Let us consider some examples.
7 289 7 17
x= =
2 2
Therefore, x = 5 or – 12.
Since x is the distance between the pole and the gate B, it must be positive.
Therefore, x = – 12 will have to be ignored. So, x = 5.
Thus, the pole has to be erected on the boundary of the park at a distance of 5m
from the gate B and 12m from the gate A.
1
Example 18 : Find the discriminant of the equation 3x2 – 2x + = 0 and hence find
3
the nature of its roots. Find them, if they are real.
1
Solution : Here a = 3, b = – 2 and c .
3
1
Therefore, discriminant b2 – 4ac = (– 2)2 – 4 × 3 × = 4 – 4 = 0.
3
Hence, the given quadratic equation has two equal real roots.
b , b , 2 2 1 1
The roots are i.e., , , i.e., , .
2a 2a 6 6 3 3
QUADRATIC EQUATIONS 91
EXERCISE 4.4
1. Find the nature of the roots of the following quadratic equations. If the real roots exist,
find them:
4.6 Summary
In this chapter, you have studied the following points:
1. A quadratic equation in the variable x is of the form ax 2 + bx + c = 0, where a, b, c are real
numbers and a ≠ 0.
2. A real number α is said to be a root of the quadratic equation ax2 + bx + c = 0, if
aα2 + bα + c = 0. The zeroes of the quadratic polynomial ax 2 + bx + c and the roots of the
quadratic equation ax2 + bx + c = 0 are the same.
3. If we can factorise ax2 + bx + c, a ≠ 0, into a product of two linear factors, then the roots
of the quadratic equation ax2 + bx + c = 0 can be found by equating each factor to zero.
4. A quadratic equation can also be solved by the method of completing the square.
5. Quadratic formula: The roots of a quadratic equation ax2 + bx + c = 0 are given by
b b 2 4ac
, provided b2 – 4ac ≥ 0.
2a
6. A quadratic equation ax2 + bx + c = 0 has
(i) two distinct real roots, if b 2 – 4ac > 0,
(ii) two equal roots (i.e., coincident roots), if b2 – 4ac = 0, and
(iii) no real roots, if b2 – 4ac < 0.
92 MATHEMATICS
e
5
h
ARITHMETIC PROGRESSIONS
pu T
is
re R
5.1 Introduction
bl
You must have observed that in nature, many things follow a certain pattern, such as
E
the petals of a sunflower, the holes of a honeycomb, the grains on a maize cob, the
spirals on a pineapple and on a pine cone etc.
be C
We now look for some patterns which occur in our day-to-day life. Some such
examples are :
(i) Reena applied for a job and got selected. She
o N
5
(iii) In a savings scheme, the amount becomes times of itself after every 3 years.
4
The maturity amount (in `) of an investment of ` 8000 after 3, 6, 9 and 12 years
no
(iv) The number of unit squares in squares with side 1, 2, 3, . . . units (see Fig. 5.2)
are, respectively
12, 22, 32, . . . .
h e
pu T
is
re R Fig. 5.2
bl
(v) Shakila put ` 100 into her daughter’s money box when she was one year old and
E
increased the amount by ` 50 every year. The amounts of money (in `) in the box
on the 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th, . . . birthday were
be C
produce a new pair in their second month and in every subsequent month (see
Fig. 5.3). Assuming no rabbit dies, the number of pairs of rabbits at the start of
the 1st, 2nd, 3rd, . . ., 6th month, respectively are :
©
1, 1, 2, 3, 5, 8
tt
no
Fig. 5.3
In the examples above, we observe some patterns. In some, we find that the
succeeding terms are obtained by adding a fixed number, in other by multiplying
with a fixed number, in another we find that they are squares of consecutive
numbers, and so on.
In this chapter, we shall discuss one of these patterns in which succeeding terms
are obtained by adding a fixed number to the preceding terms. We shall also see how
e
to find their nth terms and the sum of n consecutive terms, and use this knowledge in
solving some daily life problems.
h
pu T
5.2 Arithmetic Progressions
is
Consider the following lists of numbers :
re R
(i) 1, 2, 3, 4, . . .
bl
(ii) 100, 70, 40, 10, . . .
E
(iii) – 3, –2, –1, 0, . . .
(iv) 3, 3, 3, 3, . . .
(v) –1.0, –1.5, –2.0, –2.5, . . .
be C
will you write it? Perhaps by following a pattern or rule. Let us observe and write the
rule.
In (i), each term is 1 more than the term preceding it.
In (ii), each term is 30 less than the term preceding it.
©
This fixed number is called the common difference of the AP. Remember that
it can be positive, negative or zero.
Let us denote the first term of an AP by a1, second term by a2, . . ., nth term by
an and the common difference by d. Then the AP becomes a1, a2, a3, . . ., an.
So, a2 – a1 = a3 – a2 = . . . = an – an – 1 = d.
Some more examples of AP are:
(a) The heights ( in cm ) of some students of a school standing in a queue in the
e
morning assembly are 147 , 148, 149, . . ., 157.
(b) The minimum temperatures ( in degree celsius ) recorded for a week in the
h
month of January in a city, arranged in ascending order are
pu T
– 3.1, – 3.0, – 2.9, – 2.8, – 2.7, – 2.6, – 2.5
is
(c) The balance money ( in ` ) after paying 5 % of the total loan of ` 1000 every
re R
month is 950, 900, 850, 800, . . ., 50.
bl
(d) The cash prizes ( in ` ) given by a school to the toppers of Classes I to XII are,
E
respectively, 200, 250, 300, 350, . . ., 750.
(e) The total savings (in `) after every month for 10 months when ` 50 are saved
each month are 50, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 450, 500.
be C
It is left as an exercise for you to explain why each of the lists above is an AP.
You can see that
o N
a, a + d, a + 2d, a + 3d, . . .
represents an arithmetic progression where a is the first term and d the common
difference. This is called the general form of an AP.
©
Note that in examples (a) to (e) above, there are only a finite number of terms.
Such an AP is called a finite AP. Also note that each of these Arithmetic Progressions
(APs) has a last term. The APs in examples (i) to (v) in this section, are not finite APs
and so they are called infinite Arithmetic Progressions. Such APs do not have a
last term.
Now, to know about an AP, what is the minimum information that you need? Is it
enough to know the first term? Or, is it enough to know only the common difference?
You will find that you will need to know both – the first term a and the common
difference d.
tt
For instance if the first term a is 6 and the common difference d is 3, then
the AP is
6, 9,12, 15, . . .
no
Similarly, when
a = – 7, d = – 2, the AP is – 7, – 9, – 11, – 13, . . .
a = 1.0, d = 0.1, the AP is 1.0, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, . . .
1 1 1
a = 0, d=1 , the AP is 0, 1 , 3, 4 , 6, . . .
e
2 2 2
a = 2, d = 0, the AP is 2, 2, 2, 2, . . .
h
So, if you know what a and d are, you can list the AP. What about the other way
pu T
round? That is, if you are given a list of numbers can you say that it is an AP and then
is
find a and d? Since a is the first term, it can easily be written. We know that in an AP,
every succeeding term is obtained by adding d to the preceding term. So, d found by
re R
subtracting any term from its succeeding term, i.e., the term which immediately follows
bl
it should be same for an AP.
E
For example, for the list of numbers :
6, 9, 12, 15, . . . ,
be C
We have a2 – a1 = 9 – 6 = 3,
a3 – a2 = 12 – 9 = 3,
a4 – a3 = 15 – 12 = 3
o N
Here the difference of any two consecutive terms in each case is 3. So, the
given list is an AP whose first term a is 6 and common difference d is 3.
For the list of numbers : 6, 3, 0, – 3, . . .,
©
a2 – a 1 = 3 – 6 = – 3
a3 – a 2 = 0 – 3 = – 3
a4 – a3 = –3 – 0 = –3
Similarly this is also an AP whose first term is 6 and the common difference
is –3.
In general, for an AP a1, a2, . . ., an, we have
d = ak + 1 – ak
tt
where ak + 1 and ak are the ( k + 1)th and the kth terms respectively.
To obtain d in a given AP, we need not find all of a2 – a1, a3 – a2, a4 – a3, . . . .
It is enough to find only one of them.
no
Consider the list of numbers 1, 1, 2, 3, 5, . . . . By looking at it, you can tell that the
difference between any two consecutive terms is not the same. So, this is not an AP.
e
3 1 1 3
Example 1 : For the AP : , ,– ,– , . . ., write the first term a and the
2 2 2 2
common difference d.
h
pu T
3 1 3
Solution : Here, a= ,d= – = – 1.
is
2 2 2
re R
Remember that we can find d using any two consecutive terms, once we know that
the numbers are in AP.
bl
Example 2 : Which of the following list of numbers form an AP? If they form an AP,
E
write the next two terms :
(i) 4, 10, 16, 22, . . . (ii) 1, – 1, – 3, – 5, . . .
be C
(iii) – 2, 2, – 2, 2, – 2, . . . (iv) 1, 1, 1, 2, 2, 2, 3, 3, 3, . . .
Solution : (i) We have a2 – a1 = 10 – 4 = 6
o N
a3 – a2 = 16 – 10 = 6
a4 – a3 = 22 – 16 = 6
i.e., ak + 1 – ak is the same every time.
©
So, the given list of numbers forms an AP with the common difference d = 6.
The next two terms are: 22 + 6 = 28 and 28 + 6 = 34.
(ii) a2 – a1 = – 1 – 1 = – 2
a3 – a2 = – 3 – ( –1 ) = – 3 + 1 = – 2
a4 – a3 = – 5 – ( –3 ) = – 5 + 3 = – 2
i.e., ak + 1 – ak is the same every time.
So, the given list of numbers forms an AP with the common difference d = – 2.
tt
a3 – a2 = – 2 – 2 = – 4
As a2 – a1 ≠ a3 – a2 , the given list of numbers does not form an AP.
(iv) a2 – a1 = 1 – 1 = 0
a3 – a2 = 1 – 1 = 0
a4 – a3 = 2 – 1 = 1
Here, a2 – a1 = a3 – a2 ≠ a4 – a3.
So, the given list of numbers does not form an AP.
e
EXERCISE 5.1
h
1. In which of the following situations, does the list of numbers involved make an arithmetic
pu T
progression, and why?
is
(i) The taxi fare after each km when the fare is ` 15 for the first km and ` 8 for each
re R additional km.
1
(ii) The amount of air present in a cylinder when a vacuum pump removes of the
bl
air remaining in the cylinder at a time. 4
E
(iii) The cost of digging a well after every metre of digging, when it costs ` 150 for the
first metre and rises by ` 50 for each subsequent metre.
(iv) The amount of money in the account every year, when ` 10000 is deposited at
be C
3. For the following APs, write the first term and the common difference:
(i) 3, 1, – 1, – 3, . . . (ii) – 5, – 1, 3, 7, . . .
1 , 5 , 9 , 13 ,
(iii) ... (iv) 0.6, 1.7, 2.8, 3.9, . . .
3 3 3 3
4. Which of the following are APs ? If they form an AP, find the common difference d and
write three more terms.
5
(i) 2, 4, 8, 16, . . . (ii) 2 , , 3, 7 , . . .
tt
2 2
(iii) – 1.2, – 3.2, – 5.2, – 7.2, . . . (iv) – 10, – 6, – 2, 2, . . .
1 1 1 1
(vii) 0, – 4, – 8, –12, . . . (viii) – ,– ,– ,– ,...
2 2 2 2
e
5.3 nth Term of an AP
Let us consider the situation again, given in Section 5.1 in which Reena applied for a
h
job and got selected. She has been offered the job with a starting monthly salary of
pu T
` 8000, with an annual increment of ` 500. What would be her monthly salary for the
is
fifth year?
re R
To answer this, let us first see what her monthly salary for the second year
bl
would be.
It would be ` (8000 + 500) = ` 8500. In the same way, we can find the monthly
E
salary for the 3rd, 4th and 5th year by adding ` 500 to the salary of the previous year.
So, the salary for the 3rd year = ` (8500 + 500)
be C
= ` 9000
Salary for the 4th year = ` (9000 + 500)
= ` (8000 + 500 + 500 + 500)
©
= ` (8000 + 3 × 500)
= ` [8000 + (4 – 1) × 500] (for the 4th year)
= ` 9500
Salary for the 5th year = ` (9500 + 500)
= ` (8000+500+500+500 + 500)
= ` (8000 + 4 × 500)
= ` [8000 + (5 – 1) × 500] (for the 5th year)
tt
= ` 10000
Observe that we are getting a list of numbers
no
Now, looking at the pattern formed above, can you find her monthly salary for
the 6th year? The 15th year? And, assuming that she will still be working in the job,
what about the monthly salary for the 25th year? You would calculate this by adding
` 500 each time to the salary of the previous year to give the answer. Can we make
this process shorter? Let us see. You may have already got some idea from the way
e
we have obtained the salaries above.
Salary for the 15th year
h
= Salary for the 14th year + ` 500
pu T
is
⎡ 500 + 500 + 500 + . . . + 500⎤
re R = ` ⎢8000 +
⎥ + ` 500
⎣ 13 times ⎦
bl
= ` [8000 + 14 × 500]
E
= ` [8000 + (15 – 1) × 500] = ` 15000
i.e., First salary + (15 – 1) × Annual increment.
be C
In the same way, her monthly salary for the 25th year would be
` [8000 + (25 – 1) × 500] = ` 20000
o N
or the 25th term, and more generally, the nth term of the AP.
Let a 1, a 2, a 3, . . . be an AP whose first term a 1 is a and the common
difference is d.
Then,
the second term a2 = a + d = a + (2 – 1) d
the third term a3 = a2 + d = (a + d) + d = a + 2d = a + (3 – 1) d
the fourth term a4 = a3 + d = (a + 2d) + d = a + 3d = a + (4 – 1) d
tt
........
........
Looking at the pattern, we can say that the nth term an = a + (n – 1) d.
no
So, the nth term an of the AP with first term a and common difference d is
given by an = a + (n – 1) d.
an is also called the general term of the AP. If there are m terms in the AP, then
am represents the last term which is sometimes also denoted by l.
Let us consider some examples.
e
Solution : Here, a = 2, d = 7 – 2 = 5 and n = 10.
We have an = a + (n – 1) d
h
So, a10 = 2 + (10 – 1) × 5 = 2 + 45 = 47
pu T
Therefore, the 10th term of the given AP is 47.
is
Example 4 : Which term of the AP : 21, 18, 15, . . . is – 81? Also, is any term 0? Give
re R
reason for your answer.
bl
Solution : Here, a = 21, d = 18 – 21 = – 3 and an = – 81, and we have to find n.
E
As an = a + ( n – 1) d,
we have – 81 = 21 + (n – 1)(– 3)
be C
– 81 = 24 – 3n
– 105 = – 3n
o N
So, n = 35
Therefore, the 35th term of the given AP is – 81.
Next, we want to know if there is any n for which an = 0. If such an n is there, then
©
21 + (n – 1) (–3) = 0,
i.e., 3(n – 1) = 21
i.e., n= 8
So, the eighth term is 0.
Example 5 : Determine the AP whose 3rd term is 5 and the 7th term is 9.
Solution : We have
a3 = a + (3 – 1) d = a + 2d = 5 (1)
tt
and a7 = a + (7 – 1) d = a + 6d = 9 (2)
Solving the pair of linear equations (1) and (2), we get
no
a = 3, d = 1
Hence, the required AP is 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, . . .
Example 6 : Check whether 301 is a term of the list of numbers 5, 11, 17, 23, . . .
Solution : We have :
a2 – a1 = 11 – 5 = 6, a3 – a2 = 17 – 11 = 6, a4 – a3 = 23 – 17 = 6
As ak + 1 – ak is the same for k = 1, 2, 3, etc., the given list of numbers is an AP.
Now, a=5 and d = 6.
e
Let 301 be a term, say, the nth term of the this AP.
h
We know that
pu T
an = a + (n – 1) d
is
So, 301 = 5 + (n – 1) × 6
re R
i.e., 301 = 6n – 1
bl
302 151
So, n= =
E
6 3
But n should be a positive integer (Why?). So, 301 is not a term of the given list of
be C
numbers.
As an = a + (n – 1) d,
we have 99 = 12 + (n – 1) × 3
i.e., 87 = (n – 1) × 3
87
i.e., n–1= = 29
3
i.e., n = 29 + 1 = 30
So, there are 30 two-digit numbers divisible by 3.
tt
Example 8 : Find the 11th term from the last term (towards the first term) of the
AP : 10, 7, 4, . . ., – 62.
no
To find the 11th term from the last term, we will find the total number of terms in
the AP.
So, – 62 = 10 + (n – 1)(–3)
i.e., – 72 = (n – 1)(–3)
i.e., n – 1 = 24
e
or n = 25
So, there are 25 terms in the given AP.
h
pu T
The 11th term from the last term will be the 15th term. (Note that it will not be
is
the 14th term. Why?)
So,re R a15 = 10 + (15 – 1)(–3) = 10 – 42 = – 32
i.e., the 11th term from the last term is – 32.
bl
Alternative Solution :
E
If we write the given AP in the reverse order, then a = – 62 and d = 3 (Why?)
So, the question now becomes finding the 11th term with these a and d.
be C
Example 9 : A sum of ` 1000 is invested at 8% simple interest per year. Calculate the
interest at the end of each year. Do these interests form an AP? If so, find the interest
at the end of 30 years making use of this fact.
©
P×R×T
Simple Interest =
100
1000 × 8 ×1
So, the interest at the end of the 1st year = ` = ` 80
100
1000 × 8 × 2
The interest at the end of the 2nd year = ` = ` 160
100
1000 × 8 × 3
tt
So, the interest (in Rs) at the end of the 1st, 2nd, 3rd, . . . years, respectively are
80, 160, 240, . . .
It is an AP as the difference between the consecutive terms in the list is 80, i.e.,
d = 80. Also, a = 80.
So, to find the interest at the end of 30 years, we shall find a30.
Now, a30 = a + (30 – 1) d = 80 + 29 × 80 = 2400
So, the interest at the end of 30 years will be ` 2400.
e
Example 10 : In a flower bed, there are 23 rose plants in the first row, 21 in the
h
second, 19 in the third, and so on. There are 5 rose plants in the last row. How many
pu T
rows are there in the flower bed?
is
Solution : The number of rose plants in the 1st, 2nd, 3rd, . . ., rows are :
re R 23, 21, 19, . . ., 5
bl
It forms an AP (Why?). Let the number of rows in the flower bed be n.
E
Then a = 23, d = 21 – 23 = – 2, an = 5
As, an = a + (n – 1) d
be C
We have, 5 = 23 + (n – 1)(– 2)
i.e., – 18 = (n – 1)(– 2)
o N
i.e., n = 10
So, there are 10 rows in the flower bed.
EXERCISE 5.2
©
1. Fill in the blanks in the following table, given that a is the first term, d the common
difference and an the nth term of the AP:
a d n an
(i) 7 3 8 ...
(ii) – 18 ... 10 0
tt
(iii) ... –3 18 –5
(iv) – 18.9 2.5 ... 3.6
no
e
(A) 28 (B) 22 (C) –38 (D) – 48
2
3. In the following APs, find the missing terms in the boxes :
h
(i) 2, , 26
pu T
is
(ii) , 13, , 3
re R 1
bl
(iii) 5, , , 9
2
E
(iv) – 4, , , , , 6
be C
(v) , 38, , , , – 22
7. Find the 31st term of an AP whose 11th term is 38 and the 16th term is 73.
8. An AP consists of 50 terms of which 3rd term is 12 and the last term is 106. Find the 29th
term.
9. If the 3rd and the 9th terms of an AP are 4 and – 8 respectively, which term of this AP is
zero?
10. The 17th term of an AP exceeds its 10th term by 7. Find the common difference.
11. Which term of the AP : 3, 15, 27, 39, . . . will be 132 more than its 54th term?
12. Two APs have the same common difference. The difference between their 100th terms is
tt
15. For what value of n, are the nth terms of two APs: 63, 65, 67, . . . and 3, 10, 17, . . . equal?
16. Determine the AP whose third term is 16 and the 7th term exceeds the 5th term by 12.
17. Find the 20th term from the last term of the AP : 3, 8, 13, . . ., 253.
18. The sum of the 4th and 8th terms of an AP is 24 and the sum of the 6th and 10th terms is
44. Find the first three terms of the AP.
19. Subba Rao started work in 1995 at an annual salary of ` 5000 and received an increment
of ` 200 each year. In which year did his income reach ` 7000?
e
20. Ramkali saved ` 5 in the first week of a year and then increased her weekly savings by
` 1.75. If in the nth week, her weekly savings become ` 20.75, find n.
h
5.4 Sum of First n Terms of an AP
pu T
Let us consider the situation again
is
given in Section 5.1 in which Shakila
re R
put ` 100 into her daughter’s money
box when she was one year old,
bl
` 150 on her second birthday,
E
` 200 on her third birthday and will
continue in the same way. How much
money will be collected in the money
be C
fourth . . . birthday were respectively 100, 150, 200, 250, . . . till her 21st birthday. To
find the total amount in the money box on her 21st birthday, we will have to write each
of the 21 numbers in the list above and then add them up. Don’t you think it would be
a tedious and time consuming process? Can we make the process shorter? This would
©
be possible if we can find a method for getting this sum. Let us see.
We consider the problem given to Gauss (about whom you read in
Chapter 1), to solve when he was just 10 years old. He was asked to find the sum of
the positive integers from 1 to 100. He immediately replied that the sum is 5050. Can
you guess how did he do? He wrote :
S = 1 + 2 + 3 + . . . + 99 + 100
And then, reversed the numbers to write
S = 100 + 99 + . . . + 3 + 2 + 1
tt
We will now use the same technique to find the sum of the first n terms of an AP :
a, a + d, a + 2d, . . .
The nth term of this AP is a + (n – 1) d. Let S denote the sum of the first n terms
of the AP. We have
S = a + (a + d ) + (a + 2d ) + . . . + [a + (n – 1) d ] (1)
e
Rewriting the terms in reverse order, we have
S = [a + (n – 1) d ] + [a + (n – 2) d ] + . . . + (a + d ) + a (2)
h
On adding (1) and (2), term-wise. we get
pu T
is
[2a + (n − 1)d ] + [2a + (n − 1)d ] + ... + [2a + (n − 1)d ] + [2a + (n − 1)d ]
re R 2S =
n times
bl
or, 2S = n [2a + (n – 1) d ] (Since, there are n terms)
E
n
or, S= [2a + (n – 1) d ]
2
be C
2
n
We can also write this as S= [a + a + (n – 1) d ]
2
©
n
i.e., S= (a + an ) (3)
2
Now, if there are only n terms in an AP, then an = l, the last term.
From (3), we see that
n
S= (a + l ) (4)
2
This form of the result is useful when the first and the last terms of an AP are
given and the common difference is not given.
tt
Now we return to the question that was posed to us in the beginning. The amount
of money (in Rs) in the money box of Shakila’s daughter on 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th birthday,
. . ., were 100, 150, 200, 250, . . ., respectively.
no
This is an AP. We have to find the total money collected on her 21st birthday, i.e.,
the sum of the first 21 terms of this AP.
21 21
we have S= [2 × 100 + (21 − 1) × 50] = [ 200 + 1000]
e
2 2
21
× 1200 = 12600
h
=
2
pu T
So, the amount of money collected on her 21st birthday is ` 12600.
is
re R Hasn’t the use of the formula made it much easier to solve the problem?
We also use Sn in place of S to denote the sum of first n terms of the AP. We
bl
write S20 to denote the sum of the first 20 terms of an AP. The formula for the sum of
E
the first n terms involves four quantities S, a, d and n. If we know any three of them,
we can find the fourth.
Remark : The nth term of an AP is the difference of the sum to first n terms and the
be C
n
S = [ 2a + (n − 1) d ]
2
22
Therefore, S = [16 + 21 (−5)] = 11(16 – 105) = 11(–89) = – 979
2
So, the sum of the first 22 terms of the AP is – 979.
Example 12 : If the sum of the first 14 terms of an AP is 1050 and its first term is 10,
find the 20th term.
tt
14
so, 1050 = [ 20 + 13d ] = 140 + 91d
2
Example 13 : How many terms of the AP : 24, 21, 18, . . . must be taken so that their
sum is 78?
e
Solution : Here, a = 24, d = 21 – 24 = –3, Sn = 78. We need to find n.
h
n
We know that Sn = [ 2a + (n − 1)d ]
pu T
2
is
n n
So, 78 = [ 48 + (n − 1)(−3)] = [51 − 3n ]
re R 2 2
bl
or 3n2 – 51n + 156 = 0
or n2 – 17n + 52 = 0
E
or (n – 4)(n – 13) = 0
or n = 4 or 13
be C
Both values of n are admissible. So, the number of terms is either 4 or 13.
Remarks :
o N
1. In this case, the sum of the first 4 terms = the sum of the first 13 terms = 78.
2. Two answers are possible because the sum of the terms from 5th to 13th will be
zero. This is because a is positive and d is negative, so that some terms will be
©
positive and some others negative, and will cancel out each other.
1000
S1000 = (1 + 1000) = 500 × 1001 = 500500
2
So, the sum of the first 1000 positive integers is 500500.
no
(ii) Let Sn = 1 + 2 + 3 + . . . + n
Here a = 1 and the last term l is n.
n (1 + n) n (n + 1)
Therefore, Sn = or Sn =
2 2
So, the sum of first n positive integers is given by
n( n + 1)
Sn =
e
2
Example 15 : Find the sum of first 24 terms of the list of numbers whose nth term is
h
given by
pu T
an = 3 + 2n
is
Solution :
re R
As an = 3 + 2n,
bl
so, a1 = 3 + 2 = 5
E
a2 = 3 + 2 × 2 = 7
a3 = 3 + 2 × 3 = 9
be C
#
List of numbers becomes 5, 7, 9, 11, . . .
o N
24
Therefore, S24 = [ 2 × 5 + (24 − 1) × 2] = 12 [10 + 46] = 672
2
So, sum of first 24 terms of the list of numbers is 672.
Example 16 : A manufacturer of TV sets produced 600 sets in the third year and 700
sets in the seventh year. Assuming that the production increases uniformly by a fixed
number every year, find :
(i) the production in the 1st year (ii) the production in the 10th year
tt
Let us denote the number of TV sets manufactured in the nth year by an.
Then, a3 = 600 and a7 = 700
or, a + 2d = 600
and a + 6d = 700
Solving these equations, we get d = 25 and a = 550.
Therefore, production of TV sets in the first year is 550.
(ii) Now a10 = a + 9d = 550 + 9 × 25 = 775
e
So, production of TV sets in the 10th year is 775.
h
7
[ 2 × 550 + (7 − 1) × 25]
pu T
(iii) Also, S7 =
2
is
7
[1100 + 150] = 4375
re R =
2
bl
Thus, the total production of TV sets in first 7 years is 4375.
E
EXERCISE 5.3
be C
1, 1, 1
(iii) 0.6, 1.7, 2.8, . . ., to 100 terms. (iv) , . . ., to 11 terms.
15 12 10
2. Find the sums given below :
1
(i) 7 + 10 + 14 + . . . + 84 (ii) 34 + 32 + 30 + . . . + 10
©
2
(iii) –5 + (–8) + (–11) + . . . + (–230)
3. In an AP:
(i) given a = 5, d = 3, an = 50, find n and Sn.
(ii) given a = 7, a13 = 35, find d and S13.
(iii) given a12 = 37, d = 3, find a and S12.
(iv) given a3 = 15, S10 = 125, find d and a10.
(v) given d = 5, S9 = 75, find a and a9.
tt
4. How many terms of the AP : 9, 17, 25, . . . must be taken to give a sum of 636?
5. The first term of an AP is 5, the last term is 45 and the sum is 400. Find the number of terms
and the common difference.
6. The first and the last terms of an AP are 17 and 350 respectively. If the common difference
is 9, how many terms are there and what is their sum?
e
7. Find the sum of first 22 terms of an AP in which d = 7 and 22nd term is 149.
8. Find the sum of first 51 terms of an AP whose second and third terms are 14 and 18
h
respectively.
9. If the sum of first 7 terms of an AP is 49 and that of 17 terms is 289, find the sum of
pu T
first n terms.
is
10. Show that a1, a2, . . ., an, . . . form an AP where an is defined as below :
re R (i) an = 3 + 4n (ii) an = 9 – 5n
bl
Also find the sum of the first 15 terms in each case.
E
11. If the sum of the first n terms of an AP is 4n – n2, what is the first term (that is S1)? What
is the sum of first two terms? What is the second term? Similarly, find the 3rd, the 10th and
the nth terms.
be C
14. Find the sum of the odd numbers between 0 and 50.
15. A contract on construction job specifies a penalty for delay of completion beyond a
certain date as follows: ` 200 for the first day, ` 250 for the second day, ` 300 for the third
day, etc., the penalty for each succeeding day being ` 50 more than for the preceding day.
©
How much money the contractor has to pay as penalty, if he has delayed the work by 30
days?
16. A sum of ` 700 is to be used to give seven cash prizes to students of a school for their
overall academic performance. If each prize is ` 20 less than its preceding prize, find the
value of each of the prizes.
17. In a school, students thought of planting trees in and around the school to reduce air
pollution. It was decided that the number of trees, that each section of each class will
plant, will be the same as the class, in which they are studying, e.g., a section of Class I
will plant 1 tree, a section of Class II will plant 2 trees and so on till Class XII. There are
tt
three sections of each class. How many trees will be planted by the students?
18. A spiral is made up of successive semicircles, with centres alternately at A and B,
starting with centre at A, of radii 0.5 cm, 1.0 cm, 1.5 cm, 2.0 cm, . . . as shown in
Fig. 5.4. What is the total length of such a spiral made up of thirteen consecutive
no
22
semicircles? (Take π = )
7
h e
pu T
is
Fig. 5.4
re R [Hint : Length of successive semicircles is l1, l2, l3, l4, . . . with centres at A, B, A, B, . . .,
respectively.]
bl
19. 200 logs are stacked in the following manner: 20 logs in the bottom row, 19 in the next row,
E
18 in the row next to it and so on (see Fig. 5.5). In how many rows are the 200 logs placed
and how many logs are in the top row?
be C
o N
Fig. 5.5
20. In a potato race, a bucket is placed at the starting point, which is 5 m from the first potato,
©
and the other potatoes are placed 3 m apart in a straight line. There are ten potatoes in the
line (see Fig. 5.6).
Fig. 5.6
tt
A competitor starts from the bucket, picks up the nearest potato, runs back with it, drops
it in the bucket, runs back to pick up the next potato, runs to the bucket to drop it in, and
she continues in the same way until all the potatoes are in the bucket. What is the total
distance the competitor has to run?
no
[Hint : To pick up the first potato and the second potato, the total distance (in metres)
run by a competitor is 2 × 5 + 2 × (5 + 3)]
e
of an AP is 6 and their product is 8. Find
the sum of first sixteen terms of the AP.
h
3. A ladder has rungs 25 cm apart.
(see Fig. 5.7). The rungs decrease
pu T
uniformly in length from 45 cm at the
is
bottom to 25 cm at the top. If the top and
re R 1
the bottom rungs are 2 m apart, what is
bl
2
the length of the wood required for the
E
rungs?
25
4. The houses of a row are numbered consecutively from 1 to 49. Show that there is a value
of x such that the sum of the numbers of the houses preceding the house numbered x is
o N
equal to the sum of the numbers of the houses following it. Find this value of x.
[Hint : Sx – 1 = S49 – Sx]
5. A small terrace at a football ground comprises of 15 steps each of which is 50 m long and
©
Fig. 5.8
* These exercises are not from the examination point of view.
5.5 Summary
In this chapter, you have studied the following points :
1. An arithmetic progression (AP) is a list of numbers in which each term is obtained by
adding a fixed number d to the preceding term, except the first term. The fixed number d
is called the common difference.
e
The general form of an AP is a, a + d, a + 2d, a + 3d, . . .
2. A given list of numbers a1, a2, a3, . . . is an AP, if the differences a2 – a1, a3 – a2,
h
a4 – a3, . . ., give the same value, i.e., if ak + 1 – ak is the same for different values of k.
pu T
3. In an AP with first term a and common difference d, the nth term (or the general term) is
is
given by an = a + (n – 1) d.
re R
4. The sum of the first n terms of an AP is given by :
bl
n
S= [ 2a + (n − 1) d ]
2
E
5. If l is the last term of the finite AP, say the nth term, then the sum of all terms of the AP
is given by :
be C
n
S= (a + l )
2
o N
a+c
If a, b, c are in AP, then b = and b is called the arithmetic
2
mean of a and c.
tt
no
TRIANGLES 6
6.1 Introduction
You are familiar with triangles and many of their properties from your earlier classes.
In Class IX, you have studied congruence of triangles in detail. Recall that two figures
are said to be congruent, if they have the same shape and the same size. In this
chapter, we shall study about those figures which have the same shape but not necessarily
the same size. Two figures having the same shape (and not necessarily the same size)
are called similar figures. In particular, we shall discuss the similarity of triangles and
apply this knowledge in giving a simple proof of Pythagoras Theorem learnt earlier.
Can you guess how heights of mountains (say Mount Everest) or distances of
some long distant objects (say moon) have been found out? Do you think these have
118 MATHEMATICS
been measured directly with the help of a measuring tape? In fact, all these heights
and distances have been found out using the idea of indirect measurements, which is
based on the principle of similarity of figures (see Example 7, Q.15 of Exercise 6.3
and also Chapters 8 and 9 of this book).
What can you say about the two quadrilaterals ABCD and PQRS
(see Fig 6.2)?Are they similar? These figures appear to be similar but we cannot be
certain about it.Therefore, we must have some definition of similarity of figures and
based on this definition some rules to decide whether the two given figures are similar
or not. For this, let us look at the photographs given in Fig. 6.3:
Fig. 6.3
You will at once say that they are the photographs of the same monument
(Taj Mahal) but are in different sizes. Would you say that the three photographs are
similar? Yes,they are.
What can you say about the two photographs of the same size of the same
person one at the age of 10 years and the other at the age of 40 years? Are these
photographs similar? These photographs are of the same size but certainly they are
not of the same shape. So, they are not similar.
What does the photographer do when she prints photographs of different sizes
from the same negative? You must have heard about the stamp size, passport size and
postcard size photographs. She generally takes a photograph on a small size film, say
of 35mm size and then enlarges it into a bigger size, say 45mm (or 55mm). Thus, if we
consider any line segment in the smaller photograph (figure), its corresponding line
45 55
segment in the bigger photograph (figure) will be or of that of the line segment.
35 35
This really means that every line segment of the smaller photograph is enlarged
(increased) in the ratio 35:45 (or 35:55). It can also be said that every line segment
of the bigger photograph is reduced (decreased) in the ratio 45:35 (or 55:35). Further,
if you consider inclinations (or angles) between any pair of corresponding line segments
in the two photographs of different sizes, you shall see that these inclinations(or angles)
are always equal. This is the essence of the similarity of two figures and in particular
of two polygons. We say that:
Two polygons of the same number of sides are similar, if (i) their
corresponding angles are equal and (ii) their corresponding sides are in the
same ratio (or proportion).
120 MATHEMATICS
Note that the same ratio of the corresponding sides is referred to as the scale
factor (or the Representative Fraction) for the polygons. You must have heard that
world maps (i.e., global maps) and blue prints for the construction of a building are
prepared using a suitable scale factor and observing certain conventions.
In order to understand similarity of figures more clearly, let us perform the following
activity:
Activity 1 : Place a lighted bulb at a
point O on the ceiling and directly below
it a table in your classroom. Let us cut a
polygon, say a quadrilateral ABCD, from
a plane cardboard and place this
cardboard parallel to the ground between
the lighted bulb and the table. Then a
shadow of ABCD is cast on the table.
Mark the outline of this shadow as
A′B′C′D′ (see Fig.6.4).
Note that the quadrilateral A′B′C′D′ is
an enlargement (or magnification) of the
quadrilateral ABCD. This is because of
the property of light that light propogates
in a straight line. You may also note that Fig. 6.4
A′ lies on ray OA, B′ lies on ray OB, C′
lies on OC and D′ lies on OD. Thus, quadrilaterals A′B′C′D′ and ABCD are of the
same shape but of different sizes.
So, quadrilateral A′B′C′D′ is similiar to quadrilateral ABCD. We can also say
that quadrilateral ABCD is similar to the quadrilateral A′B′C′D′.
Here, you can also note that vertex A′ corresponds to vertex A, vertex B′
corresponds to vertex B, vertex C′ corresponds to vertex C and vertex D′ corresponds
to vertex D. Symbolically, these correspondences are represented as A′ ↔ A, B′ ↔ B,
C′ ↔ C and D′ ↔ D. By actually measuring the angles and the sides of the two
quadrilaterals, you may verify that
(i) ∠ A = ∠ A′, ∠ B = ∠ B′, ∠ C = ∠ C′, ∠ D = ∠ D′ and
AB BC CD DA .
(ii)
A B BC C D D A
This again emphasises that two polygons of the same number of sides are
similar, if (i) all the corresponding angles are equal and (ii) all the corresponding
sides are in the same ratio (or proportion).
TRIANGLES 121
From the above, you can easily say that quadrilaterals ABCD and PQRS of
Fig. 6.5 are similar.
Fig. 6.5
Remark : You can verify that if one polygon is similar to another polygon and this
second polygon is similar to a third polygon, then the first polygon is similar to the third
polygon.
You may note that in the two quadrilaterals (a square and a rectangle) of
Fig. 6.6, corresponding angles are equal, but their corresponding sides are not in the
same ratio.
Fig. 6.6
So, the two quadrilaterals are not similar. Similarly, you may note that in the two
quadrilaterals (a square and a rhombus) of Fig. 6.7, corresponding sides are in the
same ratio, but their corresponding angles are not equal. Again, the two polygons
(quadrilaterals) are not similar.
122 MATHEMATICS
Fig. 6.7
Thus, either of the above two conditions (i) and (ii) of similarity of two
polygons is not sufficient for them to be similar.
EXERCISE 6.1
1. Fill in the blanks using the correct word given in brackets :
(i) All circles are . (congruent, similar)
(ii) All squares are . (similar, congruent)
(iii) All triangles are similar. (isosceles, equilateral)
(iv) Two polygons of the same number of sides are similar, if (a) their corresponding
angles are and (b) their corresponding sides are . (equal,
proportional)
2. Give two different examples of pair of
(i) similar figures. (ii) non-similar figures.
3. State whether the following quadrilaterals are similar or not:
Fig. 6.8
TRIANGLES 123
Theorem 6.1 : If a line is drawn parallel to one side of a triangle to intersect the
other two sides in distinct points, the other two sides are divided in the same
ratio.
Proof : We are given a triangle ABC in which a line
parallel to side BC intersects other two sides AB and
AC at D and E respectively (see Fig. 6.10).
AD AE
We need to prove that .
DB EC
Let us join BE and CD and then draw DM ⊥ AC and
EN ⊥ AB. Fig. 6.10
1 1
Now, area of Δ ADE (= base × height) = AD × EN.
2 2
Recall from Class IX, that area of Δ ADE is denoted as ar(ADE).
1
So, ar(ADE) = AD × EN
2
1
Similarly, ar(BDE) = DB × EN,
2
1 1
ar(ADE) = AE × DM and ar(DEC) = EC × DM.
2 2
1
ar(ADE) AD × EN
2 AD
Therefore, = (1)
a r(BDE ) 1
DB × EN DB
2
1
AE × DM
ar(ADE ) AE
and = 2 (2)
ar(DEC) 1
EC × DM EC
2
Note that Δ BDE and DEC are on the same base DE and between the same parallels
BC and DE.
So, ar(BDE) = ar(DEC) (3)
TRIANGLES 125
AD AE
=
DB EC
Is the converse of this theorem also true (For the meaning of converse, see
Appendix 1)? To examine this, let us perform the following activity:
AB2 AC2 2
= and B2C 2 || BC (2)
B 2B C 2C 3
AB3 AC3 3
= and B 3C3 || BC (3)
B3 B C 3C 2
AB4 AC4 4
= and B4C 4 || BC (4)
B 4B C 4C 1
From (1), (2), (3) and (4), it can be observed that if a line divides two sides of a
triangle in the same ratio, then the line is parallel to the third side.
You can repeat this activity by drawing any angle XAY of different measure and
taking any number of equal parts on arms AX and AY . Each time, you will arrive at
the same result. Thus, we obtain the following theorem, which is the converse of
Theorem 6.1:
126 MATHEMATICS
AD AE
So, = (Why ?)
DB EC
AE AE
Therefore, = (Why ?)
EC EC
Adding 1 to both sides of above, you can see that E and E′ must coincide.
(Why ?)
Let us take some examples to illustrate the use of the above theorems.
AD AE
So, = (Theorem 6.1)
DB EC
DB EC
or, =
AD AE
DB EC
or, 1 = 1
AD AE
AB AC
or, =
AD AE
AD AE
So, =
AB AC Fig. 6.13
TRIANGLES 127
AG BF
i.e., = (2)
GC FC
Therefore, from (1) and (2),
AE BF
=
ED FC
PS PT
Example 3 : In Fig. 6.16, = and ∠ PST =
SQ TR
∠ PRQ. Prove that PQR is an isosceles triangle.
PS PT
Solution : It is given that Fig. 6.16
SQ TR
So, ST || QR (Theorem 6.2)
Therefore, ∠ PST = ∠ PQR (Corresponding angles) (1)
128 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 6.2
1. In Fig. 6.17, (i) and (ii), DE || BC. Find EC in (i) and AD in (ii).
Fig. 6.17
Fig. 6.22
130 MATHEMATICS
It must be noted that as done in the case of congruency of two triangles, the
similarity of two triangles should also be expressed symbolically, using correct
correspondence of their vertices. For example, for the triangles ABC and DEF of
Fig. 6.22, we cannot write Δ ABC ~ Δ EDF or Δ ABC ~ Δ FED. However, we
can write Δ BAC ~ Δ EDF.
Now a natural question arises : For checking the similarity of two triangles, say
ABC and DEF, should we always look for all the equality relations of their corresponding
angles (∠ A = ∠ D, ∠ B = ∠ E, ∠ C = ∠ F) and all the equality relations of the ratios
AB BC CA
of their corresponding sides ? Let us examine. You may recall that
DE EF FD
in Class IX, you have obtained some criteria for congruency of two triangles involving
only three pairs of corresponding parts (or elements) of the two triangles. Here also,
let us make an attempt to arrive at certain criteria for similarity of two triangles involving
relationship between less number of pairs of corresponding parts of the two triangles,
instead of all the six pairs of corresponding parts. For this, let us perform the following
activity:
Activity 4 : Draw two line segments BC and EF of two different lengths, say 3 cm
and 5 cm respectively. Then, at the points B and C respectively, construct angles PBC
and QCB of some measures, say, 60° and 40°. Also, at the points E and F, construct
angles REF and SFE of 60° and 40° respectively (see Fig. 6.23).
Fig. 6.23
TRIANGLES 131
Let rays BP and CQ intersect each other at A and rays ER and FS intersect
each other at D. In the two triangles ABC and DEF, you can see that
∠ B = ∠ E, ∠ C = ∠ F and ∠ A = ∠ D. That is, corresponding angles of these two
triangles are equal. What can you say about their corresponding sides ? Note that
BC 3 AB CA
0.6. What about and ? On measuring AB, DE, CA and FD, you
EF 5 DE FD
AB CA
will find that and are also equal to 0.6 (or nearly equal to 0.6, if there is some
DE FD
AB BC CA
error in the measurement). Thus, You can repeat this activity by
DE EF FD
constructing several pairs of triangles having their corresponding angles equal. Every
time, you will find that their corresponding sides are in the same ratio (or proportion).
This activity leads us to the following criterion for similarity of two triangles.
Theorem 6.3 : If in two triangles, corresponding angles are equal, then their
corresponding sides are in the same ratio (or proportion) and hence the two
triangles are similar.
This criterion is referred to as the AAA
(Angle–Angle–Angle) criterion of
similarity of two triangles.
This theorem can be proved by taking two
triangles ABC and DEF such that
∠ A = ∠ D, ∠ B = ∠ E and ∠ C = ∠ F
(see Fig. 6.24) Fig. 6.24
Cut DP = AB and DQ = AC and join PQ.
So, Δ ABC ≅ Δ DPQ (Why ?)
This gives ∠ B = ∠ P = ∠ E and PQ || EF (How?)
DP DQ
Therefore, = (Why?)
PE QF
AB AC
i.e., = (Why?)
DE DF
AB BC AB BC AC
Similarly, = and so .
DE EF DE EF DF
Remark : If two angles of a triangle are respectively equal to two angles of another
triangle, then by the angle sum property of a triangle their third angles will also be
equal. Therefore, AAA similarity criterion can also be stated as follows:
132 MATHEMATICS
If two angles of one triangle are respectively equal to two angles of another
triangle, then the two triangles are similar.
This may be referred to as the AA similarity criterion for two triangles.
You have seen above that if the three angles of one triangle are respectively
equal to the three angles of another triangle, then their corresponding sides are
proportional (i.e., in the same ratio). What about the converse of this statement? Is the
converse true? In other words, if the sides of a triangle are respectively proportional to
the sides of another triangle, is it true that their corresponding angles are equal? Let us
examine it through an activity :
Activity 5 : Draw two triangles ABC and DEF such that AB = 3 cm, BC = 6 cm,
CA = 8 cm, DE = 4.5 cm, EF = 9 cm and FD = 12 cm (see Fig. 6.25).
Fig. 6.25
AB BC CA 2
So, you have : (each equal to )
DE EF FD 3
Now measure ∠ A, ∠ B, ∠ C, ∠ D, ∠ E and ∠ F. You will observe that
∠ A = ∠ D, ∠ B = ∠ E and ∠ C = ∠ F, i.e., the corresponding angles of the two
triangles are equal.
You can repeat this activity by drawing several such triangles (having their sides
in the same ratio). Everytime you shall see that their corresponding angles are equal.
It is due to the following criterion of similarity of two triangles:
Fig. 6.26
Cut DP = AB and DQ = AC and join PQ.
DP DQ
It can be seen that = and PQ || EF (How?)
PE QF
So, ∠P=∠ E and ∠ Q = ∠ F.
DP DQ PQ
Therefore, = =
DE DF EF
DP DQ BC
So, = = (Why?)
DE DF EF
So, BC = PQ (Why?)
Thus, Δ ABC ≅ Δ DPQ (Why ?)
So, ∠ A = ∠ D, ∠ B = ∠ E and ∠ C = ∠ F (How ?)
Remark : You may recall that either of the two conditions namely, (i) corresponding
angles are equal and (ii) corresponding sides are in the same ratio is not sufficient for
two polygons to be similar. However, on the basis of Theorems 6.3 and 6.4, you can
now say that in case of similarity of the two triangles, it is not necessary to check both
the conditions as one condition implies the other.
Let us now recall the various criteria for congruency of two triangles learnt in
Class IX. You may observe that SSS similarity criterion can be compared with the SSS
congruency criterion.This suggests us to look for a similarity criterion comparable to
SAS congruency criterion of triangles. For this, let us perform an activity.
Activity 6 : Draw two triangles ABC and DEF such that AB = 2 cm, ∠ A = 50°,
AC = 4 cm, DE = 3 cm, ∠ D = 50° and DF = 6 cm (see Fig.6.27).
134 MATHEMATICS
Fig. 6.27
AB AC 2
Here, you may observe that = (each equal to ) and ∠ A (included
DE DF 3
between the sides AB and AC) = ∠ D (included between the sides DE and DF). That
is, one angle of a triangle is equal to one angle of another triangle and sides including
these angles are in the same ratio (i.e., proportion). Now let us measure ∠ B, ∠ C,
∠ E and ∠ F.
You will find that ∠ B = ∠ E and ∠ C = ∠ F. That is, ∠ A = ∠ D, ∠ B = ∠ E and
∠ C = ∠ F. So, by AAA similarity criterion, Δ ABC ~ Δ DEF. You may repeat this
activity by drawing several pairs of such triangles with one angle of a triangle equal to
one angle of another triangle and the sides including these angles are proportional.
Everytime, you will find that the triangles are similar. It is due to the following criterion
of similarity of triangles:
Theorem 6.5 : If one angle of a triangle is equal to one angle of the other
triangle and the sides including these angles are proportional, then the two
triangles are similar.
This criterion is referred to as
the SAS (Side–Angle–Side)
similarity criterion for two
triangles.
As before, this theorem can
be proved by taking two triangles
ABC and DEF such that
AB AC
(< 1) and ∠ A = ∠ D
DE DF
(see Fig. 6.28). Cut DP = AB, DQ Fig. 6.28
= AC and join PQ.
TRIANGLES 135
Fig. 6.29
Solution : PQ || RS (Given)
So, ∠P= ∠S (Alternate angles)
and ∠Q= ∠R
Also, ∠ POQ = ∠ SOR (Vertically opposite angles)
Therefore, Δ POQ ~ Δ SOR (AAA similarity criterion)
Example 5 : Observe Fig. 6.30 and then find ∠ P.
Fig. 6.30
Solution : In Δ ABC and Δ PQR,
136 MATHEMATICS
AB 3.8 1 , BC 6 1 CA 3 3 1
and
RQ 7.6 2 QP 12 2 PR 6 3 2
AB BC CA
That is,
RQ QP PR
OA OD Fig. 6.31
So, = (1)
OC OB
Also, we have ∠ AOD = ∠ COB (Vertically opposite angles) (2)
Therefore, from (1) and (2), Δ AOD ~ Δ COB (SAS similarity criterion)
So, ∠ A = ∠ C and ∠ D = ∠ B
(Corresponding angles of similar triangles)
4.8 + x 3.6 90
i.e., = (90 cm = m = 0.9 m)
x 0.9 100
i.e., 4.8 + x = 4x
i.e., 3x = 4.8
i.e., x = 1.6
So, the shadow of the girl after walking for 4 seconds is 1.6 m long.
Example 8 : In Fig. 6.33, CM and RN are
respectively the medians of Δ ABC and
Δ PQR. If Δ ABC ~ Δ PQR, prove that :
(i) Δ AMC ~ Δ PNR
CM AB
(ii)
RN PQ
(iii) Δ CMB ~ Δ RNQ
Fig. 6.33
Solution : (i) Δ ABC ~ Δ PQR (Given)
AB BC CA
So, = (1)
PQ QR RP
and ∠ A = ∠ P, ∠ B = ∠ Q and ∠ C = ∠ R (2)
But AB = 2 AM and PQ = 2 PN
(As CM and RN are medians)
2AM CA
So, from (1), =
2 PN RP
138 MATHEMATICS
AM CA
i.e., = (3)
PN RP
Also, ∠ MAC = ∠ NPR [From (2)] (4)
So, from (3) and (4),
Δ AMC ~ Δ PNR (SAS similarity) (5)
CM CA
(ii) From (5), = (6)
RN RP
CA AB
But = [From (1)] (7)
RP PQ
CM AB
Therefore, = [From (6) and (7)] (8)
RN PQ
AB BC
(iii) Again, = [From (1)]
PQ QR
CM BC
Therefore, = [From (8)] (9)
RN QR
CM AB 2 BM
Also, =
RN PQ 2 QN
CM BM
i.e., = (10)
RN QN
CM BC BM
i.e., = [From (9) and (10)]
RN QR QN
Therefore, Δ CMB ~ Δ RNQ (SSS similarity)
[Note : You can also prove part (iii) by following the same method as used for proving
part (i).]
EXERCISE 6.3
1. State which pairs of triangles in Fig. 6.34 are similar. Write the similarity criterion used by
you for answering the question and also write the pairs of similar triangles in the symbolic
form :
TRIANGLES 139
Fig. 6.34
∠ OAB.
OA OB
triangles, show that
OC OD
140 MATHEMATICS
QR QT
4. In Fig. 6.36, and ∠ 1 = ∠ 2. Show
QS PR
that Δ PQS ~ Δ TQR.
CA BC Fig. 6.38
(ii)
PA MP
10. CD and GH are respectively the bisectors
of ∠ ACB and ∠ EGF such that D and H lie
on sides AB and FE of Δ ABC and Δ EFG
respectively. If Δ ABC ~ Δ FEG, show that:
CD AC
(i)
GH FG
(ii) Δ DCB ~ Δ HGE
(iii) Δ DCA ~ Δ HGF Fig. 6.39
TRIANGLES 141
2 2 2
ar (ABC) AB BC CA
We need to prove that
ar (PQR) PQ QR RP
For finding the areas of the two triangles, we draw altitudes AM and PN of the
triangles.
1
Now, ar (ABC) = BC × AM
2
1
and ar (PQR) = QR × PN
2
1
ar (ABC) BC × AM BC × AM
So, 2
= 1 (1)
ar (PQR) QR × PN
QR × PN
2
Now, in Δ ABM and Δ PQN,
∠B= ∠ Q (As Δ ABC ~ Δ PQR)
and ∠M= ∠ N (Each is of 90°)
So, Δ ABM ~ Δ PQN (AA similarity criterion)
AM AB
Therefore, = PQ (2)
PN
Also, Δ ABC ~ Δ PQR (Given)
AB BC CA
So, = (3)
PQ QR RP
ar (ABC) AB AM
Therefore,
ar (PQR) = PQ PN [From (1) and (3)]
AB AB
= [From (2)]
PQ PQ
2
AB
=
PQ
Now using (3), we get
2 2 2
ar (ABC) AB BC CA
ar (PQR) = PQ QR
RP
Let us take an example to illustrate the use of this theorem.
TRIANGLES 143
Fig. 6.43
Solution : We have XY || AC (Given)
So, ∠ BXY = ∠ A and ∠ BYX = ∠ C (Corresponding angles)
Therefore, Δ ABC ~ Δ XBY (AA similarity criterion)
2
ar (ABC) AB
So, ar (XBY) = XB (Theorem 6.6) (1)
XB 1
or, =
AB 2
XB 1
or, 1– = 1–
AB 2
AB – XB 2 1 AX 2 1 2 2
or, , i.e., = .
AB 2 AB 2 2
EXERCISE 6.4
1. Let Δ ABC ~ Δ DEF and their areas be, respectively, 64 cm2 and 121 cm2. If EF =
15.4 cm, find BC.
2. Diagonals of a trapezium ABCD with AB || DC intersect each other at the point O.
If AB = 2 CD, find the ratio of the areas of triangles AOB and COD.
144 MATHEMATICS
So, from (1) and (2), triangles on both sides of the perpendicular BD are similar
to the whole triangle ABC.
Also, since Δ ADB ~ Δ ABC
and Δ BDC ~ Δ ABC
So, Δ ADB ~ Δ BDC (From Remark in Section 6.2)
The above discussion leads to the following theorem :
Theorem 6.8 : In a right triangle, the square of the hypotenuse is equal to the
sum of the squares of the other two sides.
Proof : We are given a right triangle ABC right angled at B.
AD AB
So, = (Sides are proportional) Fig. 6.46
AB AC
or, AD . AC = AB 2 (1)
CD BC
So, =
BC AC
or, CD . AC = BC 2 (2)
146 MATHEMATICS
Fig. 6.47
Now, from Δ PQR, we have :
PR 2 = PQ2 + QR2 (Pythagoras Theorem,
as ∠ Q = 90°)
or, PR 2 = AB2 + BC2 (By construction) (1)
TRIANGLES 147
Example 11 : A ladder is placed against a wall such that its foot is at a distance
of 2.5 m from the wall and its top reaches a window 6 m above the ground. Find the
length of the ladder.
148 MATHEMATICS
2
AC
AB (L is the mid-point of AC)
2
or, BL =
2
2
AC2
or, BL2 = AB 2
4
or, 4 BL2 = AC2 + 4 AB 2 (2)
From Δ CMA,
CM2 = AC2 + AM2
2
AB
or, CM = AC +
2 2
(M is the mid-point of AB)
2
AB2
or, CM2 = AC2 +
4
or 4 CM2 = 4 AC2 + AB2 (3)
Adding (2) and (3), we have
4 (BL 2 + CM2) = 5 (AC2 + AB 2)
i.e., 4 (BL 2 + CM2) = 5 BC2 [From (1)]
EXERCISE 6.5
1. Sides of triangles are given below. Determine which of them are right triangles.
In case of a right triangle, write the length of its hypotenuse.
(i) 7 cm, 24 cm, 25 cm
(ii) 3 cm, 8 cm, 6 cm
(iii) 50 cm, 80 cm, 100 cm
(iv) 13 cm, 12 cm, 5 cm
2. PQR is a triangle right angled at P and M is a
point on QR such that PM ⊥ QR. Show that
PM2 = QM . MR.
3. In Fig. 6.53, ABD is a triangle right angled at A
and AC ⊥ BD. Show that
(i) AB2 = BC . BD
(ii) AC2 = BC . DC
Fig. 6.53
(iii) AD2 = BD . CD
4. ABC is an isosceles triangle right angled at C. Prove that AB2 = 2AC2.
5. ABC is an isosceles triangle with AC = BC. If AB2 = 2 AC2, prove that ABC is a right
triangle.
6. ABC is an equilateral triangle of side 2a. Find each of its altitudes.
7. Prove that the sum of the squares of the sides of a rhombus is equal to the sum of the
squares of its diagonals.
TRIANGLES 151
Fig. 6.60
* These exercises are not from examination point of view.
TRIANGLES 153
2
BC 1
(ii) AB2 = AD2 – BC . DM + (iii) AC2 + AB2 = 2 AD2 + BC2
2 2
6. Prove that the sum of the squares of the diagonals of parallelogram is equal to the sum
of the squares of its sides.
7. In Fig. 6.61, two chords AB and CD intersect each other at the point P. Prove that :
(i) Δ APC ~ Δ DPB (ii) AP . PB = CP . DP
8. In Fig. 6.62, two chords AB and CD of a circle intersect each other at the point P
(when produced) outside the circle. Prove that
BD AB
such that Prove that AD is the
CD AC
bisector of ∠ BAC.
Fig. 6.63
10. Nazima is fly fishing in a stream. The tip of
her fishing rod is 1.8 m above the surface
of the water and the fly at the end of the
string rests on the water 3.6 m away and
2.4 m from a point directly under the tip of
the rod. Assuming that her string
(from the tip of her rod to the fly) is taut,
how much string does she have out
(see Fig. 6.64)? If she pulls in the string at
the rate of 5 cm per second, what will be
the horizontal distance of the fly from her
after 12 seconds? Fig. 6.64
154 MATHEMATICS
6.7 Summary
In this chapter you have studied the following points :
1. Two figures having the same shape but not necessarily the same size are called similar
figures.
2. All the congruent figures are similar but the converse is not true.
3. Two polygons of the same number of sides are similar, if (i) their corresponding angles
are equal and (ii) their corresponding sides are in the same ratio (i.e., proportion).
4. If a line is drawn parallel to one side of a triangle to intersect the other two sides in
distinct points, then the other two sides are divided in the same ratio.
5. If a line divides any two sides of a triangle in the same ratio, then the line is parallel to the
third side.
6. If in two triangles, corresponding angles are equal, then their corresponding sides are in
the same ratio and hence the two triangles are similar (AAA similarity criterion).
7. If in two triangles, two angles of one triangle are respectively equal to the two angles of
the other triangle, then the two triangles are similar (AA similarity criterion).
8. If in two triangles, corresponding sides are in the same ratio, then their corresponding
angles are equal and hence the triangles are similar (SSS similarity criterion).
9. If one angle of a triangle is equal to one angle of another triangle and the sides including
these angles are in the same ratio (proportional), then the triangles are similar
(SAS similarity criterion).
10. The ratio of the areas of two similar triangles is equal to the square of the ratio of their
corresponding sides.
11. If a perpendicular is drawn from the vertex of the right angle of a right triangle to the
hypotenuse, then the triangles on both sides of the perpendicular are similar to the
whole triangle and also to each other.
12. In a right triangle, the square of the hypotenuse is equal to the sum of the squares of the
other two sides (Pythagoras Theorem).
13. If in a triangle, square of one side is equal to the sum of the squares of the other two
sides, then the angle opposite the first side is a right angle.
COORDINATE GEOMETRY 7
7.1 Introduction
In Class IX, you have studied that to locate the position of a point on a plane, we
require a pair of coordinate axes. The distance of a point from the y-axis is called its
x-coordinate, or abscissa. The distance of a point from the x-axis is called its
y-coordinate, or ordinate. The coordinates of a point on the x-axis are of the form
(x, 0), and of a point on the y-axis are of the form (0, y).
Here is a play for you. Draw a set of a pair of perpendicular axes on a graph
paper. Now plot the following points and join them as directed: Join the point A(4, 8) to
B(3, 9) to C(3, 8) to D(1, 6) to E(1, 5) to F(3, 3) to G(6, 3) to H(8, 5) to I(8, 6) to
J(6, 8) to K(6, 9) to L(5, 8) to A. Then join the points P(3.5, 7), Q (3, 6) and R(4, 6) to
form a triangle. Also join the points X(5.5, 7), Y(5, 6) and Z(6, 6) to form a triangle.
Now join S(4, 5), T(4.5, 4) and U(5, 5) to form a triangle. Lastly join S to the points
(0, 5) and (0, 6) and join U to the points (9, 5) and (9, 6). What picture have you got?
Also, you have seen that a linear equation in two variables of the form
ax + by + c = 0, (a, b are not simultaneously zero), when represented graphically,
gives a straight line. Further, in Chapter 2, you have seen the graph of
y = ax2 + bx + c (a ≠ 0), is a parabola. In fact, coordinate geometry has been developed
as an algebraic tool for studying geometry of figures. It helps us to study geometry
using algebra, and understand algebra with the help of geometry. Because of this,
coordinate geometry is widely applied in various fields such as physics, engineering,
navigation, seismology and art!
In this chapter, you will learn how to find the distance between the two points
whose coordinates are given, and to find the area of the triangle formed by three given
points. You will also study how to find the coordinates of the point which divides a line
segment joining two given points in a given ratio.
156 MATHEMATICS
Fig. 7.4
Therefore, PQ = x2 x1 2 y2 y1 2
Note that since distance is always non-negative, we take only the positive square
root. So, the distance between the points P(x1, y1) and Q(x2, y2) is
PQ = x2 – x 1 + y2 – y1 ,
2 2
OP = x2 y 2 .
Example 1 : Do the points (3, 2), (–2, –3) and (2, 3) form a triangle? If so, name the
type of triangle formed.
Solution : Let us apply the distance formula to find the distances PQ, QR and PR,
where P(3, 2), Q(–2, –3) and R(2, 3) are the given points. We have
PQ = (3 2) 2 (2 3) 2 5 2 5 2 50 = 7.07 (approx.)
Also, PQ2 + PR2 = QR2, by the converse of Pythagoras theorem, we have ∠ P = 90°.
Therefore, PQR is a right triangle.
Example 2 : Show that the points (1, 7), (4, 2), (–1, –1) and (– 4, 4) are the vertices
of a square.
Solution : Let A(1, 7), B(4, 2), C(–1, –1) and D(– 4, 4) be the given points. One way
of showing that ABCD is a square is to use the property that all its sides should be
equal and both its digonals should also be equal. Now,
AB = (1 – 4) 2 (7 2) 2 9 25 34
BC = (4 1) 2 (2 1) 2 25 9 34
CD = (–1 4) 2 (–1 – 4) 2 9 25 34
DA = (1 4) 2 (7 – 4) 2 25 9 34
AC = (1 1) 2 (7 1) 2 4 64 68
BD = (4 4) 2 (2 4) 2 64 4 68
AB = (6 3) 2 (4 1) 2 9 9 18 3 2
BC = (8 – 6) 2 (6 – 4) 2 4 4 8 2 2
AC = (8 – 3) 2 (6 – 1) 2 25 25 50 5 2
BP = (– 4 – 0) 2 (3 – 9) 2 16 36 52
Note : Using the remark above, we see that (0, 9) is the intersection of the y-axis and
the perpendicular bisector of AB.
EXERCISE 7.1
1. Find the distance between the following pairs of points :
(i) (2, 3), (4, 1) (ii) (– 5, 7), (– 1, 3) (iii) (a, b), (– a, – b)
2. Find the distance between the points (0, 0) and (36, 15). Can you now find the distance
between the two towns A and B discussed in Section 7.2.
3. Determine if the points (1, 5), (2, 3) and (– 2, – 11) are collinear.
4. Check whether (5, – 2), (6, 4) and (7, – 2) are the vertices of an isosceles triangle.
5. In a classroom, 4 friends are
seated at the points A, B, C and
D as shown in Fig. 7.8. Champa
and Chameli walk into the class
and after observing for a few
minutes Champa asks Chameli,
“Don’t you think ABCD is a
square?” Chameli disagrees.
Using distance formula, find
which of them is correct.
6. Name the type of quadrilateral
formed, if any, by the following
points, and give reasons for
your answer:
(i) (– 1, – 2), (1, 0), (– 1, 2), (– 3, 0)
(ii) (–3, 5), (3, 1), (0, 3), (–1, – 4)
(iii) (4, 5), (7, 6), (4, 3), (1, 2) Fig. 7.8
7. Find the point on the x-axis which is equidistant from (2, –5) and (–2, 9).
8. Find the values of y for which the distance between the points P(2, – 3) and Q(10, y) is
10 units.
162 MATHEMATICS
9. If Q(0, 1) is equidistant from P(5, –3) and R(x, 6), find the values of x. Also find the
distances QR and PR.
10. Find a relation between x and y such that the point (x, y) is equidistant from the point
(3, 6) and (– 3, 4).
m1x2 m2 x1 , m1 y2 m2 y1
(2)
m1 m2 m1 m2
This is known as the section formula.
This can also be derived by drawing perpendiculars from A, P and B on the
y-axis and proceeding as above.
If the ratio in which P divides AB is k : 1, then the coordinates of the point P will be
kx2 x1 , ky2 y1
k 1 k 1
Special Case : The mid-point of a line segment divides the line segment in the ratio
1 : 1. Therefore, the coordinates of the mid-point P of the join of the points A(x1, y1 )
and B(x2, y2 ) is
1 x1 1 x2 , 1 y1 1 y2 x1 x2 , y1 y2
11 11 2 2 .
Let us solve a few examples based on the section formula.
164 MATHEMATICS
Example 6 : Find the coordinates of the point which divides the line segment joining
the points (4, – 3) and (8, 5) in the ratio 3 : 1 internally.
Solution : Let P(x, y) be the required point. Using the section formula, we get
Example 7 : In what ratio does the point (– 4, 6) divide the line segment joining the
points A(– 6, 10) and B(3, – 8)?
Solution : Let (– 4, 6) divide AB internally in the ratio m1 : m2 . Using the section
formula, we get
3m1 6 m2 – 8m1 10 m2
(– 4, 6) = , (1)
m1 m2 m1 m2
3 m1 6 m2 8m1 10 m2
So, –4= and 6
m1 m2 m1 m2
3m1 6m2
Now, –4= gives us
m1 m2
– 4m1 – 4m2 = 3m1 – 6m2
i.e., 7m1 = 2m2
i.e., m1 : m2 = 2 : 7
You should verify that the ratio satisfies the y-coordinate also.
m1
8 10
8m1 10 m2 m2
Now, = (Dividing throughout by m2 )
m1 m2 m1
1
m2
2
8 10
7 6
= 2
1
7
C OORDINATE GEOMETRY 165
Therefore, the point (– 4, 6) divides the line segment joining the points A(– 6, 10) and
B(3, – 8) in the ratio 2 : 7.
m1
Alternatively : The ratio m1 : m2 can also be written as :1, or k : 1. Let (– 4, 6)
m2
divide AB internally in the ratio k : 1. Using the section formula, we get
3k 6 , 8 k 10
(– 4, 6) = (2)
k1 k 1
3k 6
So, –4=
k 1
i.e., – 4k – 4 = 3k – 6
i.e., 7k = 2
i.e., k:1= 2:7
You can check for the y-coordinate also.
So, the point (– 4, 6) divides the line segment joining the points A(– 6, 10) and
B(3, – 8) in the ratio 2 : 7.
Note : You can also find this ratio by calculating the distances PA and PB and taking
their ratios provided you know that A, P and B are collinear.
Example 8 : Find the coordinates of the points of trisection (i.e., points dividing in
three equal parts) of the line segment joining the points A(2, – 2) and B(– 7, 4).
Solution : Let P and Q be the points of
trisection of AB i.e., AP = PQ = QB
(see Fig. 7.11). Fig. 7.11
Therefore, P divides AB internally in the ratio 1 : 2. Therefore, the coordinates of P, by
applying the section formula, are
Therefore, the coordinates of the points of trisection of the line segment joining A and
B are (–1, 0) and (– 4, 2).
Note : We could also have obtained Q by noting that it is the mid-point of PB. So, we
could have obtained its coordinates using the mid-point formula.
Example 9 : Find the ratio in which the y-axis divides the line segment joining the
points (5, – 6) and (–1, – 4). Also find the point of intersection.
Solution : Let the ratio be k : 1. Then by the section formula, the coordinates of the
k 5 , 4 k 6
point which divides AB in the ratio k : 1 are
k 1 k 1
This point lies on the y-axis, and we know that on the y-axis the abscissa is 0.
k 5
Therefore, =0
k 1
So, k=5
That is, the ratio is 5 : 1. Putting the value of k = 5, we get the point of intersection as
13
0, .
3
Example 10 : If the points A(6, 1), B(8, 2), C(9, 4) and D(p, 3) are the vertices of a
parallelogram, taken in order, find the value of p.
Solution : We know that diagonals of a parallelogram bisect each other.
So, the coordinates of the mid-point of AC = coordinates of the mid-point of BD
6 9, 1 4 8 p, 2 3
i.e., =
2 2 2 2
15 , 5 8 p, 5
i.e., =
2 2 2 2
15 8p
so, =
2 2
i.e., p= 7
C OORDINATE GEOMETRY 167
EXERCISE 7.2
1. Find the coordinates of the point which divides the join of (–1, 7) and (4, –3) in the
ratio 2 : 3.
2. Find the coordinates of the points of trisection of the line segment joining (4, –1)
and (–2, –3).
3. To conduct Sports Day activities, in
your rectangular shaped school
ground ABCD, lines have been
drawn with chalk powder at a
distance of 1m each. 100 flower pots
have been placed at a distance of 1m
from each other along AD, as shown
1
in Fig. 7.12. Niharika runs th the
4
distance AD on the 2nd line and
1
posts a green flag. Preet runs th
5
the distance AD on the eighth line
and posts a red flag. What is the
distance between both the flags? If
Rashmi has to post a blue flag exactly
halfway between the line segment
joining the two flags, where should
she post her flag? Fig. 7.12
4. Find the ratio in which the line segment joining the points (– 3, 10) and (6, – 8) is divided
by (– 1, 6).
5. Find the ratio in which the line segment joining A(1, – 5) and B(– 4, 5) is divided by the
x-axis. Also find the coordinates of the point of division.
6. If (1, 2), (4, y), (x, 6) and (3, 5) are the vertices of a parallelogram taken in order, find
x and y.
7. Find the coordinates of a point A, where AB is the diameter of a circle whose centre is
(2, – 3) and B is (1, 4).
8. If A and B are (– 2, – 2) and (2, – 4), respectively, find the coordinates of P such that
3
AP = AB and P lies on the line segment AB.
7
9. Find the coordinates of the points which divide the line segment joining A(– 2, 2) and
B(2, 8) into four equal parts.
10. Find the area of a rhombus if its vertices are (3, 0), (4, 5), (– 1, 4) and (– 2, – 1) taken in
1
order. [Hint : Area of a rhombus = (product of its diagonals)]
2
168 MATHEMATICS
Example 11 : Find the area of a triangle whose vertices are (1, –1), (– 4, 6) and
(–3, –5).
Solution : The area of the triangle formed by the vertices A(1, –1), B(– 4, 6) and
C (–3, –5), by using the formula above, is given by
1
1 (6 5) (4) (5 1) (3) (1 6)
2
1
= (11 16 21) = 24
2
So, the area of the triangle is 24 square units.
Example 12 : Find the area of a triangle formed by the points A(5, 2), B(4, 7) and
C (7, – 4).
Solution : The area of the triangle formed by the vertices A(5, 2), B(4, 7) and
C (7, – 4) is given by
1
5 (7 4) 4 ( 4 2) 7 (2 7)
2
1 4
= (55 24 35) = 2
2 2
Since area is a measure, which cannot be negative, we will take the numerical value
of – 2, i.e., 2. Therefore, the area of the triangle = 2 square units.
Example 13 : Find the area of the triangle formed by the points P(–1.5, 3), Q(6, –2)
and R(–3, 4).
Solution : The area of the triangle formed by the given points is equal to
1
1.5(2 4) 6(4 3) (3) (3 2)
2
1
= (9 6 15) 0
2
Can we have a triangle of area 0 square units? What does this mean?
If the area of a triangle is 0 square units, then its vertices will be collinear.
Example 14 : Find the value of k if the points A(2, 3), B(4, k) and C(6, –3) are
collinear.
Solution : Since the given points are collinear, the area of the triangle formed by them
must be 0, i.e.,
170 MATHEMATICS
1
2(k 3) 4 (3 3) 6(3 k) = 0
2
1
i.e., ( 4k ) 0
2
Therefore, k=0
Let us verify our answer.
1
area of Δ ABC = 2(0 3) 4 ( 3 3) 6 (3 0) 0
2
Example 15 : If A(–5, 7), B(– 4, –5), C(–1, –6) and D(4, 5) are the vertices of a
quadrilateral, find the area of the quadrilateral ABCD.
Solution : By joining B to D, you will get two triangles ABD and BCD.
1
Now the area of Δ ABD = 5( 5 5) ( 4) (5 7) 4 (7 5)
2
1 106
= (50 8 48) 53 square units
2 2
1
Also, the area of Δ BCD = 4( 6 5) – 1(5 5) 4( 5 6)
2
1
= (44 10 4) 19 square units
2
So, the area of quadrilateral ABCD = 53 + 19 = 72 square units.
Note : To find the area of a polygon, we divide it into triangular regions, which have
no common area, and add the areas of these regions.
EXERCISE 7.3
1. Find the area of the triangle whose vertices are :
(i) (2, 3), (–1, 0), (2, – 4) (ii) (–5, –1), (3, –5), (5, 2)
2. In each of the following find the value of ‘k’, for which the points are collinear.
(i) (7, –2), (5, 1), (3, k) (ii) (8, 1), (k, – 4), (2, –5)
3. Find the area of the triangle formed by joining the mid-points of the sides of the triangle
whose vertices are (0, –1), (2, 1) and (0, 3). Find the ratio of this area to the area of the
given triangle.
4. Find the area of the quadrilateral whose vertices, taken in order, are (– 4, – 2), (– 3, – 5),
(3, – 2) and (2, 3).
5. You have studied in Class IX, (Chapter 9, Example 3), that a median of a triangle divides
it into two triangles of equal areas. Verify this result for Δ ABC whose vertices are
A(4, – 6), B(3, –2) and C(5, 2).
C OORDINATE GEOMETRY 171
(v) If A(x1, y1), B(x2, y2) and C(x3, y 3) are the vertices of Δ ABC, find the coordinates of
the centroid of the triangle.
8. ABCD is a rectangle formed by the points A(–1, –1), B(– 1, 4), C(5, 4) and D(5, – 1). P, Q,
R and S are the mid-points of AB, BC, CD and DA respectively. Is the quadrilateral
PQRS a square? a rectangle? or a rhombus? Justify your answer.
7.5 Summary
In this chapter, you have studied the following points :
m1 x2 m2 x1 , m1 y2 m2 y1
x= y=
m1 m2 m1 m2
INTRODUCTION TO
e
8
h
TRIGONOMETRY
pu T
is
re R There is perhaps nothing which so occupies the
middle position of mathematics as trigonometry.
bl
– J.F. Herbart (1890)
E
8.1 Introduction
You have already studied about triangles, and in particular, right triangles, in your
be C
earlier classes. Let us take some examples from our surroundings where right triangles
can be imagined to be formed. For instance :
o N
e
the balloon intially it was at point A.
When both the mother and daughter
came out to see it, it had already
h
travelled to another point B. Can you
pu T
find the altitude of B from the ground? Fig. 8.3
is
In all the situations given above, the distances or heights can be found by using
re R
some mathematical techniques, which come under a branch of mathematics called
bl
‘trigonometry’. The word ‘trigonometry’ is derived from the Greek words ‘tri’
(meaning three), ‘gon’ (meaning sides) and ‘metron’ (meaning measure). In fact,
E
trigonometry is the study of relationships between the sides and angles of a triangle.
The earliest known work on trigonometry was recorded in Egypt and Babylon. Early
be C
astronomers used it to find out the distances of the stars and planets from the Earth.
Even today, most of the technologically advanced methods used in Engineering and
Physical Sciences are based on trigonometrical concepts.
o N
In this chapter, we will study some ratios of the sides of a right triangle with
respect to its acute angles, called trigonometric ratios of the angle. We will restrict
our discussion to acute angles only. However, these ratios can be extended to other
angles also. We will also define the trigonometric ratios for angles of measure 0° and
©
90°. We will calculate trigonometric ratios for some specific angles and establish
some identities involving these ratios, called trigonometric identities.
e
them trigonometric ratios.
The trigonometric ratios of the angle A
h
in right triangle ABC (see Fig. 8.4) are defined
pu T
as follows :
is
Fig. 8.5
side opposite to angle A BC
sine of ∠ A = =
re R hypotenuse AC
bl
side adjacent to angle A AB
cosine of ∠ A = =
E
hypotenuse AC
side opposite to angle A BC
be C
tangent of ∠ A = =
side adjacent to angle A AB
1 hypotenuse AC
= =
o N
cosecant of ∠ A =
sine of ∠ A side opposite to angle A BC
1 hypotenuse AC
secant of ∠ A = = =
cosine of ∠ A side adjacent to angle A AB
©
e
it is. The word jiva was translated into sinus, which
means curve, when the Arabic version was translated
h
into Latin. Soon the word sinus, also used as sine,
pu T
became common in mathematical texts throughout
is
Europe. An English Professor of astronomy Edmund
Gunter (1581–1626), first used the abbreviated
re R Aryabhata
notation ‘sin’. C.E. 476 – 550
bl
The origin of the terms ‘cosine’ and ‘tangent’ was much later. The cosine function
E
arose from the need to compute the sine of the complementary angle. Aryabhatta
called it kotijya. The name cosinus originated with Edmund Gunter. In 1674, the
English Mathematician Sir Jonas Moore first used the abbreviated notation ‘cos’.
be C
Chapter 6, recall the AA similarity criterion. Using the criterion, you will see that the
triangles PAM and CAB are similar. Therefore, by the property of similar triangles,
the corresponding sides of the triangles are proportional.
no
AM AP MP
So, we have = = ⋅
AB AC BC
MP BC
From this, we find = = sin A .
AP AC
AM AB MP BC
Similarly, = = cos A, = = tan A and so on.
AP AC AM AB
This shows that the trigonometric ratios of angle A in Δ PAM not differ from
those of angle A in Δ CAB.
e
In the same way, you should check that the value of sin A (and also of other
h
trigonometric ratios) remains the same in Δ QAN also.
pu T
From our observations, it is now clear that the values of the trigonometric
is
ratios of an angle do not vary with the lengths of the sides of the triangle, if
re R
the angle remains the same.
Note : For the sake of convenience, we may write sin2A, cos2A, etc., in place of
bl
(sin A)2, (cos A)2, etc., respectively. But cosec A = (sin A)–1 ≠ sin–1 A (it is called sine
E
inverse A). sin–1 A has a different meaning, which will be discussed in higher classes.
Similar conventions hold for the other trigonometric ratios as well. Sometimes, the
Greek letter θ (theta) is also used to denote an angle.
be C
We have defined six trigonometric ratios of an acute angle. If we know any one
of the ratios, can we obtain the other ratios? Let us see.
o N
1
If in a right triangle ABC, sin A = ,
3
BC 1
then this means that = , i.e., the
AC 3
©
Therefore,
So, we get AB = 2 2 k (Why is AB not – 2 2 k ?)
no
AB 2 2 k 2 2
Now, =
cos A = =
AC 3k 3
Similarly, you can obtain the other trigonometric ratios of the angle A.
Remark : Since the hypotenuse is the longest side in a right triangle, the value of
sin A or cos A is always less than 1 (or, in particular, equal to 1).
Let us consider some examples.
4
Example 1 : Given tan A = , find the other
3
e
trigonometric ratios of the angle A.
Solution : Let us first draw a right Δ ABC
h
(see Fig 8.8).
pu T
BC 4
is
Now, we know that tan A = = .
re R AB 3
Therefore, if BC = 4k, then AB = 3k, where k is a
bl
positive number.
Fig. 8.8
E
Now, by using the Pythagoras Theorem, we have
AC2 = AB2 + BC2 = (4k)2 + (3k)2 = 25k2
be C
So, AC = 5k
Now, we can write all the trigonometric ratios using their definitions.
o N
BC 4k 4
sin A = = =
AC 5k 5
AB 3k 3
cos A = = =
©
AC 5k 5
1 3 1 5 1 5
Therefore, cot A = = , cosec A = = and sec A = = ⋅
tan A 4 sin A 4 cos A 3
AC Fig. 8.9
We have sin B =
AB
PR
and sin Q =
PQ
AC PR
Then =
AB PQ
AC AB
Therefore, = = k , say (1)
PR PQ
Now, using Pythagoras theorem,
e
BC = AB2 − AC 2
h
and QR = PQ 2 – PR 2
pu T
is
BC AB2 − AC2 k 2 PQ 2 − k 2 PR 2 k PQ 2 − PR 2
= = =k
So,
re R QR
=
PQ 2 − PR 2 PQ 2 − PR 2 PQ 2 − PR 2
(2)
bl
From (1) and (2), we have
E
AC AB BC
= =
PR PQ QR
be C
AC 20 , BC 21
tt
⎝ 29 ⎠ ⎝ 29 ⎠ 292 841
2 2
⎛ 21 ⎞ ⎛ 20 ⎞ (21 + 20) (21 − 20) 41
and (ii) cos θ – sin θ = ⎜ ⎟ − ⎜ ⎟ =
2 2 = .
⎝ 29 ⎠ ⎝ 29 ⎠
2
29 841
BC
Solution : In Δ ABC, tan A = = 1 (see Fig 8.11)
AB
e
i.e., BC = AB
Fig. 8.11
h
Let AB = BC = k, where k is a positive number.
pu T
is
Now,
re R AC = AB2 + BC2
bl
= (k ) 2 + (k ) 2 = k 2
E
BC 1 AB 1
Therefore, sin A = = and cos A = =
be C
AC 2 AC 2
⎛ 1 ⎞⎛ 1 ⎞
So, 2 sin A cos A = 2 ⎜ ⎟⎜ ⎟ = 1, which is the required value.
o N
⎝ 2 ⎠⎝ 2 ⎠
Example 5 : In Δ OPQ, right-angled at P,
OP = 7 cm and OQ – PQ = 1 cm (see Fig. 8.12).
©
i.e., PQ = 24 cm and OQ = 1 + PQ = 25 cm
no
Fig. 8.12
7 24
So, sin Q = and cos Q = ⋅
25 25
EXERCISE 8.1
1. In Δ ABC, right-angled at B, AB = 24 cm, BC = 7 cm. Determine :
(i) sin A, cos A
(ii) sin C, cos C
2. In Fig. 8.13, find tan P – cot R.
e
3,
3. If sin A = calculate cos A and tan A.
4
h
4. Given 15 cot A = 8, find sin A and sec A.
pu T
13 ,
is
5. Given sec θ = calculate all other trigonometric ratios. Fig. 8.13
re R 12
6. If ∠ A and ∠ B are acute angles such that cos A = cos B, then show that ∠ A = ∠ B.
bl
7, (1 + sin θ) (1 − sin θ) ,
7. If cot θ = evaluate : (i) (ii) cot2 θ
E
8 (1 + cos θ) (1 − cos θ)
1 − tan 2 A
= cos2 A – sin2A or not.
be C
4
(v) sin θ = for some angle θ.
3
From geometry, you are already familiar with the construction of angles of 30°, 45°,
60° and 90°. In this section, we will find the values of the trigonometric ratios for these
angles and, of course, for 0°.
e
Fig. 8.14
Then by Pythagoras Theorem, AC2 = AB2 + BC2 = a2 + a2 = 2a2,
h
and, therefore, AC = a 2 ⋅
pu T
is
Using the definitions of the trigonometric ratios, we have :
re R sin 45° =
side opposite to angle 45° BC
= =
a
=
1
bl
hypotenuse AC a 2 2
E
side adjacent to angle 45° AB a 1
cos 45° = = = =
hypotenuse AC a 2 2
be C
1 1 1
Also, cosec 45° = = 2 , sec 45° = = 2 , cot 45° = = 1.
sin 45° cos 45° tan 45°
©
As you know, for finding the trigonometric ratios, we need to know the lengths of the
sides of the triangle. So, let us suppose that AB = 2a.
1
Then, BD = BC = a
2
and AD2 = AB2 – BD2 = (2a)2 – (a)2 = 3a2,
e
Therefore, AD = a 3
h
Now, we have :
BD a 1 AD a 3 3
pu T
sin 30° = = = , cos 30° = = =
is
AB 2a 2 AB 2a 2
BD a 1
= =
re R tan 30° =
AD a 3 3
.
bl
1 1 2
= 2, sec 30° = =
E
Also, cosec 30° =
sin 30° cos 30° 3
1
= 3.
be C
cot 30° =
tan 30°
Similarly,
o N
AD a 3 3 1
sin 60° = = = , cos 60° = , tan 60° = 3,
AB 2a 2 2
2 , 1
cosec 60° = sec 60° = 2 and cot 60° = ⋅
3 3
©
Fig. 8.17
When ∠ A is very close to 0°, BC gets very close to 0 and so the value of
BC
sin A = is very close to 0. Also, when ∠ A is very close to 0°, AC is nearly the
AC
AB
same as AB and so the value of cos A = is very close to 1.
AC
e
This helps us to see how we can define the values of sin A and cos A when
A = 0°. We define : sin 0° = 0 and cos 0° = 1.
h
Using these, we have :
pu T
is
sin 0° 1 ,
re Rtan 0° = = 0, cot 0° = which is not defined. (Why?)
cos 0° tan 0°
bl
1 1 ,
sec 0° = = 1 and cosec 0° = which is again not defined.(Why?)
E
cos 0° sin 0°
Now, let us see what happens to the trigonometric ratios of ∠ A, when it is made
larger and larger in Δ ABC till it becomes 90°. As ∠ A gets larger and larger, ∠ C gets
be C
smaller and smaller. Therefore, as in the case above, the length of the side AB goes on
decreasing. The point A gets closer to point B. Finally when ∠ A is very close to 90°,
o N
∠ C becomes very close to 0° and the side AC almost coincides with side BC
(see Fig. 8.18).
©
Fig. 8.18
When ∠ C is very close to 0°, ∠ A is very close to 90°, side AC is nearly the
same as side BC, and so sin A is very close to 1. Also when ∠ A is very close to 90°,
tt
∠ C is very close to 0°, and the side AB is nearly zero, so cos A is very close to 0.
So, we define : sin 90° = 1 and cos 90° = 0.
no
Now, why don’t you find the other trigonometric ratios of 90°?
We shall now give the values of all the trigonometric ratios of 0°, 30°, 45°, 60°
and 90° in Table 8.1, for ready reference.
Table 8.1
1 1 3
sin A 0 1
2 2 2
e
3 1 1
cos A 1 0
h
2 2 2
pu T
1
is
tan A 0 1 3 Not defined
re R 3
bl
2
cosec A Not defined 2 2 1
3
E
2
sec A 1 2 Not defined
be C
3 2
1
cot A Not defined 1 0
o N
3 3
Remark : From the table above you can observe that as ∠ A increases from 0° to
90°, sin A increases from 0 to 1 and cos A decreases from 1 to 0.
©
Let us illustrate the use of the values in the table above through some examples.
AB
= tan C
BC
no
5 1
i.e., = tan 30° =
BC 3
which gives BC = 5 3 cm
AB
sin 30° = (Why?)
AC
1 5
i.e., =
2 AC
e
i.e., AC = 10 cm
h
Note that alternatively we could have used Pythagoras theorem to determine the third
pu T
side in the example above,
is
i.e., AC = AB2 + BC2 = 52 + (5 3) 2 cm = 10cm.
re R
bl
Example 7 : In Δ PQR, right - angled at
E
Q (see Fig. 8.20), PQ = 3 cm and PR = 6 cm.
Determine ∠ QPR and ∠ PRQ.
Solution : Given PQ = 3 cm and PR = 6 cm.
be C
PQ
Therefore, = sin R
PR
o N
Fig. 8.20
3 1
or sin R = =
6 2
©
and B.
1
Solution : Since, sin (A – B) = , therefore, A – B = 30° (Why?) (1)
2
no
1
Also, since cos (A + B) = , therefore, A + B = 60° (Why?) (2)
2
Solving (1) and (2), we get : A = 45° and B = 15°.
EXERCISE 8.2
1. Evaluate the following :
(i) sin 60° cos 30° + sin 30° cos 60° (ii) 2 tan2 45° + cos2 30° – sin2 60°
cos 45° sin 30° + tan 45° – cosec 60°
(iii) sec 30° + cosec 30° (iv)
sec 30° + cos 60° + cot 45°
e
5 cos 2 60° + 4 sec 2 30° − tan 2 45°
(v)
sin 2 30° + cos 2 30°
h
2. Choose the correct option and justify your choice :
pu T
is
2 tan 30°
(i) =
1 + tan 2 30°
re R (A) sin 60° (B) cos 60° (C) tan 60° (D) sin 30°
bl
1 − tan 2 45°
=
E
(ii)
1 + tan 2 45°
(A) tan 90° (B) 1 (C) sin 45° (D) 0
be C
2 tan 30°
(iv) =
1 − tan 2 30°
(A) cos 60° (B) sin 60° (C) tan 60° (D) sin 30°
©
1
3. If tan (A + B) = 3 and tan (A – B) =; 0° < A + B ≤ 90°; A > B, find A and B.
3
4. State whether the following are true or false. Justify your answer.
(i) sin (A + B) = sin A + sin B.
(ii) The value of sin θ increases as θ increases.
(iii) The value of cos θ increases as θ increases.
(iv) sin θ = cos θ for all values of θ.
(v) cot A is not defined for A = 0°.
tt
BC AB BC
sin A = cos A = tan A = ⎫
AC AC AB ⎪
⎪
⎬ (1)
AC AC AB ⎪
cosec A =
BC
sec A =
AB
cot A =
BC ⎪⎭
e
Now let us write the trigonometric ratios for ∠ C = 90° – ∠ A.
h
For convenience, we shall write 90° – A instead of 90° – ∠ A.
pu T
What would be the side opposite and the side adjacent to the angle 90° – A?
is
You will find that AB is the side opposite and BC is the side adjacent to the angle
re R
90° – A. Therefore,
bl
AB , BC , AB
⎫
E
sin (90° – A) = cos (90° – A) = tan (90° – A) =
AC AC BC ⎪
⎪
⎬ (2)
AC , AC , BC ⎪
be C
AB BC
sin (90° – A) = = cos A and cos (90° – A) = = sin A
AC AC
©
AB BC
Also, tan (90° – A) = = cot A , cot (90° – A) = = tan A
BC AB
AC AC
sec (90° – A) = = cosec A , cosec (90° – A) = = sec A
BC AB
So, sin (90° – A) = cos A, cos (90° – A) = sin A,
tan (90° – A) = cot A, cot (90° – A) = tan A,
sec (90° – A) = cosec A, cosec (90° – A) = sec A,
tt
for all values of angle A lying between 0° and 90°. Check whether this holds for
A = 0° or A = 90°.
no
Note : tan 0° = 0 = cot 90°, sec 0° = 1 = cosec 90° and sec 90°, cosec 0°, tan 90° and
cot 0° are not defined.
Now, let us consider some examples.
tan 65°
Example 9 : Evaluate .
cot 25°
Solution : We know : cot A = tan (90° – A)
So, cot 25° = tan (90° – 25°) = tan 65°
e
tan 65° tan 65°
i.e., = =1
cot 25° tan 65°
h
Example 10 : If sin 3A = cos (A – 26°), where 3A is an acute angle, find the value of
pu T
A.
is
Solution : We are given that sin 3A = cos (A – 26°).
re R (1)
Since sin 3A = cos (90° – 3A), we can write (1) as
bl
cos (90° – 3A) = cos (A – 26°)
E
Since 90° – 3A and A – 26° are both acute angles, therefore,
90° – 3A = A – 26°
be C
Example 11 : Express cot 85° + cos 75° in terms of trigonometric ratios of angles
between 0° and 45°.
Solution : cot 85° + cos 75° = cot (90° – 5°) + cos (90° – 15°)
©
EXERCISE 8.3
1. Evaluate :
2. Show that :
tt
⎛B + C⎞ A
sin ⎜ ⎟ = cos ⋅
⎝ 2 ⎠ 2
7. Express sin 67° + cos 75° in terms of trigonometric ratios of angles between 0° and 45°.
e
8.5 Trigonometric Identities
You may recall that an equation is called an identity
h
when it is true for all values of the variables involved.
pu T
Similarly, an equation involving trigonometric ratios
is
of an angle is called a trigonometric identity, if it is
true for all values of the angle(s) involved.
re R
In this section, we will prove one trigonometric
bl
identity, and use it further to prove other useful
E
trigonometric identities. Fig. 8.22
In Δ ABC, right-angled at B (see Fig. 8.22), we have:
be C
i.e., ⎜ ⎟ = ⎜ ⎟
⎝ AC ⎠ ⎝ AC ⎠ ⎝ AC ⎠
i.e., (cos A)2 + (sin A)2 = 1
i.e., cos2 A + sin2 A = 1 (2)
This is true for all A such that 0° ≤ A ≤ 90°. So, this is a trigonometric identity.
Let us now divide (1) by AB2. We get
+ =
AB2 AB2 AB2
2 2 2
⎛ AB ⎞ ⎛ BC ⎞ ⎛ AC ⎞
⎟ +⎜
no
or, ⎜ ⎟ = ⎜ ⎟
⎝ AB ⎠ ⎝ AB ⎠ ⎝ AB ⎠
i.e., 1 + tan2 A = sec 2 A (3)
Is this equation true for A = 0°? Yes, it is. What about A = 90°? Well, tan A and
sec A are not defined for A = 90°. So, (3) is true for all A such that 0° ≤ A < 90°.
Let us see what we get on dividing (1) by BC2. We get
e
2 2 2
⎛ AB ⎞ ⎛ BC ⎞ ⎛ AC ⎞
⎟ +⎜
h
i.e., ⎜ ⎟ = ⎜ ⎟
⎝ BC ⎠ ⎝ BC ⎠ ⎝ BC ⎠
pu T
is
i.e., cot2 A + 1 = cosec 2 A (4)
re R
Note that cosec A and cot A are not defined for A = 0°. Therefore (4) is true for
all A such that 0° < A ≤ 90°.
bl
Using these identities, we can express each trigonometric ratio in terms of other
E
trigonometric ratios, i.e., if any one of the ratios is known, we can also determine the
values of other trigonometric ratios.
be C
Let us see how we can do this using these identities. Suppose we know that
1
tan A = ⋅ Then, cot A = 3.
o N
1 4, 2 3
Since, sec2 A = 1 + tan2 A = 1 + = sec A = , and cos A = ⋅
3 3 3 2
©
3 1
Again, sin A = 1 − cos 2 A = 1 − = . Therefore, cosec A = 2.
4 2
Example 12 : Express the ratios cos A, tan A and sec A in terms of sin A.
sin A sin A 1 1
Hence, tan A = = and sec A = =
cos A 1 – sin 2 A cos A 1 − sin 2 A
⎛ 1 ⎞ ⎛ 1 sin A ⎞
LHS = sec A (1 – sin A)(sec A + tan A) = ⎜ ⎟ (1 − sin A) ⎜ + ⎟
⎝ cos A ⎠ ⎝ cos A cos A ⎠
(1 − sin A) (1 + sin A) 1 − sin 2 A
e
= =
cos 2 A cos 2 A
h
cos 2 A
= = 1 = RHS
pu T
cos 2 A
is
re R cot A – cos A cosec A – 1
Example 14 : Prove that =
cot A + cos A cosec A + 1
bl
E
cos A
− cos A
cot A – cos A sin A
Solution : LHS = =
be C
cos A ⎜ −1 ⎟ ⎜ − 1⎟
⎝ sin A ⎠ = ⎝ sin A ⎠ = cosec A – 1
= = RHS
⎛ 1 ⎞ ⎛ 1 ⎞ cosec A + 1
cos A ⎜ + 1⎟ ⎜ + 1⎟
⎝ sin A ⎠ ⎝ sin A ⎠
©
sin θ − cos θ + 1 1
Example 15 : Prove that = , using the identity
sin θ + cos θ − 1 sec θ − tan θ
sec2 θ = 1 + tan2 θ.
Solution : Since we will apply the identity involving sec θ and tan θ, let us first
convert the LHS (of the identity we need to prove) in terms of sec θ and tan θ by
dividing numerator and denominator by cos θ.
tt
– 1 − tan θ + sec θ
=
(tan θ − sec θ + 1) (tan θ − sec θ)
e
–1 1
= tan θ − sec θ = sec θ − tan θ
,
h
pu T
which is the RHS of the identity, we are required to prove.
is
re R EXERCISE 8.4
bl
1. Express the trigonometric ratios sin A, sec A and tan A in terms of cot A.
E
2. Write all the other trigonometric ratios of ∠ A in terms of sec A.
3. Evaluate :
be C
1 + tan 2 A
(iv) =
1 + cot 2 A
tt
tan θ cot θ
(iii) 1 − cot θ + 1 − tan θ = 1 + sec θ cosec θ
e
(v)
cos A + sin A – 1
1 + sin A sin θ − 2 sin 3 θ
h
(vi) = sec A + tan A (vii) = tan θ
1 – sin A 2 cos3 θ − cos θ
pu T
is
(viii) (sin A + cosec A)2 + (cos A + sec A)2 = 7 + tan2 A + cot2 A
1
re R (ix) (cosec A – sin A) (sec A – cos A) = tan A + cot A
bl
[Hint : Simplify LHS and RHS separately]
E
2
⎛ 1 + tan 2 A ⎞ ⎛ 1 − tan A ⎞
(x) ⎜ 2 ⎟= ⎜ ⎟ = tan2 A
⎝ 1 + cot A ⎠ ⎝ 1 – cot A ⎠
be C
8.6 Summary
o N
d
SOME APPLICATIONS OF
he
TRIGONOMETRY 9
is
9.1 Introduction
bl
In the previous chapter, you have studied about trigonometric ratios. In this chapter,
you will be studying about some ways in which trigonometry is used in the life around
you. Trigonometry is one of the most ancient subjects studied by scholars all over the
pu
world. As we have said in Chapter 8, trigonometry was invented because its need
arose in astronomy. Since then the astronomers have used it, for instance, to calculate
be T
distances from the Earth to the planets and stars. Trigonometry is also used in geography
and in navigation. The knowledge of trigonometry is used to construct maps, determine
re
the position of an island in relation to the longitudes and latitudes.
o R
In this chapter, we will see how trigonometry is used for finding the heights and
distances of various objects, without actually measuring them.
d
Let us consider Fig. 8.1 of prvious chapter, which is redrawn below in Fig. 9.1.
he
is
bl
pu
Fig. 9.1
be T
In this figure, the line AC drawn from the eye of the student to the top of the
re
minar is called the line of sight. The student is looking at the top of the minar. The
o R
angle BAC, so formed by the line of sight with the horizontal, is called the angle of
elevation of the top of the minar from the eye of the student.
Thus, the line of sight is the line drawn from the eye of an observer to the point
tt E
in the object viewed by the observer. The angle of elevation of the point viewed is
the angle formed by the line of sight with the horizontal when the point being viewed is
C
above the horizontal level, i.e., the case when we raise our head to look at the object
(see Fig. 9.2).
no N
©
Fig. 9.2
S OME A PPLICATIONS OF TRIGONOMETRY 197
Now, consider the situation given in Fig. 8.2. The girl sitting on the balcony is
looking down at a flower pot placed on a stair of the temple. In this case, the line of
sight is below the horizontal level. The angle so formed by the line of sight with the
horizontal is called the angle of depression.
d
Thus, the angle of depression of a point on the object being viewed is the angle
formed by the line of sight with the horizontal when the point is below the horizontal
he
level, i.e., the case when we lower our head to look at the point being viewed
(see Fig. 9.3).
is
bl
pu
Fig. 9.3
be T
Now, you may identify the lines of sight, and the angles so formed in Fig. 8.3.
re
o R
the following:
(i) the distance DE at which the student is standing from the foot of the minar
C
Assuming that the above three conditions are known, how can we determine the
height of the minar?
In the figure, CD = CB + BD. Here, BD = AE, which is the height of the student.
©
BC AB ,
Therefore, tan A = or cot A = which on solving would give us BC.
AB BC
By adding AE to BC, you will get the height of the minar.
d
Now let us explain the process, we have just discussed, by solving some problems.
he
Example 1 : A tower stands vertically on the ground. From a point on the ground,
which is 15 m away from the foot of the tower, the angle of elevation of the top of the
tower is found to be 60°. Find the height of the tower.
Solution : First let us draw a simple diagram to
is
represent the problem (see Fig. 9.4). Here AB
represents the tower, CB is the distance of the point
from the tower and ∠ ACB is the angle of elevation.
bl
We need to determine the height of the tower, i.e.,
AB. Also, ACB is a triangle, right -angled at B.
To solve the problem, we choose the trigonometric
pu
ratio tan 60° (or cot 60°), as the ratio involves AB
and BC.
be T
AB
Now, tan 60° =
re
BC
o R
AB Fig. 9.4
i.e., 3 =
15
tt E
i.e., AB = 15 3
C
Solution : In Fig. 9.5, the electrician is required to reach the point B on the pole AD.
So, BD = AD – AB = (5 – 1.3)m = 3.7 m.
Here, BC represents the ladder. We need to find its length, i.e., the hypotenuse of the
right triangle BDC.
d
Now, can you think which trigonometic ratio should we consider?
he
It should be sin 60°.
BD 3.7 3
So, = sin 60° or =
BC BC 2
is
3.7 × 2
Therefore, BC = = 4.28 m (approx.)
3
bl
i.e., the length of the ladder should be 4.28 m.
DC 1
Now, = cot 60° =
pu
BD 3
3.7
be T
Therefore, she should place the foot of the ladder at a distance of 2.14 m from the
pole.
tt E
AE
Now, tan 45° =
DE
AE
d
i.e., 1=
28.5
Therefore, AE = 28.5
he
So the height of the chimney (AB) = (28.5 + 1.5) m = 30 m.
Example 4 : From a point P on the ground the angle of elevation of the top of a 10 m
tall building is 30°. A flag is hoisted at the top of the building and the angle of elevation
is
of the top of the flagstaff from P is 45°. Find the length of the flagstaff and the
distance of the building from the point P. (You may take 3 = 1.732)
bl
Solution : In Fig. 9.7, AB denotes the height of the building, BD the flagstaff and P
the given point. Note that there are two right triangles PAB and PAD. We are required
pu
to find the length of the flagstaff, i.e., DB and the distance of the building from the
point P, i.e., PA.
Since, we know the height of the building AB, we
be T
AB
We have tan 30° =
AP
tt E
1 10
i.e., =
3 AP
C
Therefore, AP = 10 3
Fig. 9.7
no N
AD 10 + x
Now, in right Δ PAD, tan 45° = =
AP 10 3
10 + x
Therefore, 1=
10 3
S OME A PPLICATIONS OF TRIGONOMETRY 201
i.e., x = 10 ( )
3 − 1 = 7.32
d
Example 5 : The shadow of a tower standing
on a level ground is found to be 40 m longer
he
when the Sun’s altitude is 30° than when it is
60°. Find the height of the tower.
Solution : In Fig. 9.8, AB is the tower and
BC is the length of the shadow when the
is
Sun’s altitude is 60°, i.e., the angle of
elevation of the top of the tower from the tip
of the shadow is 60° and DB is the length of
bl
the shadow, when the angle of elevation is Fig. 9.8
30°.
AB
In Δ ABC, tan 60° =
BC
h
tt E
or, 3 = x (1)
AB
In Δ ABD,
C
tan 30° =
BD
1 h
i.e., = (2)
no N
3 x + 40
From (1), we have h= x 3
( )
Putting this value in (2), we get x 3 3 = x + 40, i.e., 3x = x + 40
©
i.e., x = 20
Example 6 : The angles of depression of the top and the bottom of an 8 m tall building
from the top of a multi-storeyed building are 30° and 45°, respectively. Find the height
of the multi-storeyed building and the distance between the two buildings.
Solution : In Fig. 9.9, PC denotes the multi-
d
storyed building and AB denotes the 8 m tall
building. We are interested to determine the
he
height of the multi-storeyed building, i.e., PC
and the distance between the two buildings,
i.e., AC.
Look at the figure carefully. Observe that
is
PB is a transversal to the parallel lines PQ
and BD. Therefore, ∠ QPB and ∠ PBD are
alternate angles, and so are equal.
bl
So ∠ PBD = 30°. Similarly, ∠ PAC = 45°. Fig. 9.9
In right Δ PBD, we have
pu
PD 1
= tan 30° = or BD = PD 3
BD 3
be T
PC
o R
= tan 45° = 1
AC
i.e., PC = AC
tt E
8 8 ( )
3+ 1
= 4 ( 3 + 1) m.
no N
=
( )( )
This gives PD =
3 −1 3 +1 3−1
d
a point on the bridge at a height
of 3 m, i.e., DP = 3 m. We are
interested to determine the width Fig. 9.10
he
of the river, which is the length
of the side AB of the Δ APB.
Now, AB = AD + DB
is
In right Δ APD, ∠ A = 30°.
PD
So, tan 30° =
bl
AD
1 3
i.e., = or AD = 3 3 m
pu
3 AD
Also, in right Δ PBD, ∠ B = 45°. So, BD = PD = 3 m.
be T
Now, AB = BD + AD = 3 + 3 3 = 3 (1 + 3 ) m.
re
( )
o R
EXERCISE 9.1
1. A circus artist is climbing a 20 m long rope, which is
C
the foot of the tree to the point where the top Fig. 9.11
touches the ground is 8 m. Find the height of the
tree.
3. A contractor plans to install two slides for the children to play in a park. For the children
below the age of 5 years, she prefers to have a slide whose top is at a height of 1.5 m, and
204 MATHEMATICS
is inclined at an angle of 30° to the ground, whereas for elder children, she wants to have
a steep slide at a height of 3m, and inclined at an angle of 60° to the ground. What
should be the length of the slide in each case?
4. The angle of elevation of the top of a tower from a point on the ground, which is 30 m
d
away from the foot of the tower, is 30°. Find the height of the tower.
5. A kite is flying at a height of 60 m above the ground. The string attached to the kite is
he
temporarily tied to a point on the ground. The inclination of the string with the ground
is 60°. Find the length of the string, assuming that there is no slack in the string.
6. A 1.5 m tall boy is standing at some distance from a 30 m tall building. The angle of
elevation from his eyes to the top of the building increases from 30° to 60° as he walks
towards the building. Find the distance he walked towards the building.
is
7. From a point on the ground, the angles of elevation of the bottom and the top of a
transmission tower fixed at the top of a 20 m high building are 45° and 60° respectively.
Find the height of the tower.
bl
8. A statue, 1.6 m tall, stands on the top of a pedestal. From a point on the ground, the
angle of elevation of the top of the statue is 60° and from the same point the angle of
elevation of the top of the pedestal is 45°. Find the height of the pedestal.
pu
9. The angle of elevation of the top of a building from the foot of the tower is 30° and the
angle of elevation of the top of the tower from the foot of the building is 60°. If the tower
be T
which is 80 m wide. From a point between them on the road, the angles of elevation of
the top of the poles are 60° and 30°, respectively. Find the height of the poles and the
distances of the point from the poles.
tt E
the canal.
12. From the top of a 7 m high building, the angle of elevation of the top of a cable tower is
60° and the angle of depression of its foot is 45°. Determine the height of the tower.
13. As observed from the top of a 75 m high lighthouse from the sea-level, the angles of
depression of two ships are 30° and 45°. If one ship is exactly behind the other on the
same side of the lighthouse, find the distance between the two ships.
S OME A PPLICATIONS OF TRIGONOMETRY 205
d
the eyes of the girl at any instant is
60°. After some time, the angle of
he
elevation reduces to 30° (see Fig. 9.13).
Find the distance travelled by the
balloon during the interval. Fig. 9.13
is
15. A straight highway leads to the foot of a tower. A man standing at the top of the tower
observes a car at an angle of depression of 30°, which is approaching the foot of the
tower with a uniform speed. Six seconds later, the angle of depression of the car is found
bl
to be 60°. Find the time taken by the car to reach the foot of the tower from this point.
16. The angles of elevation of the top of a tower from two points at a distance of 4 m and
9 m from the base of the tower and in the same straight line with it are complementary.
pu
Prove that the height of the tower is 6 m.
9.3 Summary
be T
1. (i) The line of sight is the line drawn from the eye of an observer to the point in the
object viewed by the observer.
(ii) The angle of elevation of an object viewed, is the angle formed by the line of sight
tt E
with the horizontal when it is above the horizontal level, i.e., the case when we raise
our head to look at the object.
C
(iii) The angle of depression of an object viewed, is the angle formed by the line of sight
with the horizontal when it is below the horizontal level, i.e., the case when we lower
our head to look at the object.
no N
2. The height or length of an object or the distance between two distant objects can be
determined with the help of trigonometric ratios.
©
206 MATHEMATICS
d
he
CIRCLES 10
is
10.1 Introduction
bl
You have studied in Class IX that a circle is a collection of all points in a plane
which are at a constant distance (radius) from a fixed point (centre). You have
also studied various terms related to a circle like chord, segment, sector, arc etc.
pu
Let us now examine the different situations that can arise when a circle and a line
are given in a plane.
be T
So, let us consider a circle and a line PQ. There can be three possibilities given
in Fig. 10.1 below:
re
o R
tt E
C
no N
Fig. 10.1
©
In Fig. 10.1 (i), the line PQ and the circle have no common point. In this case,
PQ is called a non-intersecting line with respect to the circle. In Fig. 10.1 (ii), there
are two common points A and B that the line PQ and the circle have. In this case, we
call the line PQ a secant of the circle. In Fig. 10.1 (iii), there is only one point A which
is common to the line PQ and the circle. In this case, the line is called a tangent to the
circle.
You might have seen a pulley fitted over a well which is used
in taking out water from the well. Look at Fig. 10.2. Here the rope
on both sides of the pulley, if considered as a ray, is like a tangent
to the circle representing the pulley.
d
Is there any position of the line with respect to the circle
other than the types given above? You can see that there cannot
he
be any other type of position of the line with respect to the circle.
Fig. 10.2
In this chapter, we will study about the existence of the tangents
to a circle and also study some of their properties.
is
In the previous section, you have seen that a tangent* to a circle is a line that
intersects the circle at only one point.
bl
To understand the existence of the tangent to a circle at a point, let us perform
the following activities:
Activity 1 : Take a circular wire and attach a straight wire AB at a point P of the
pu
circular wire so that it can rotate about the point P in a plane. Put the system on a table
and gently rotate the wire AB about the point P to get different positions of the straight
wire [see Fig. 10.3(i)].
be T
with the point P in the position A′B′ of A′′B′′. Again note, what happens if ‘AB’ is
rotated rightwards about P? The common point R3 gradually comes nearer and nearer
to P and ultimately coincides with P. So, what we see is:
The tangent to a circle is a special case of the secant, when the two end
points of its corresponding chord coincide.
*The word ‘tangent’ comes from the Latin word ‘tangere’, which means to touch and was
introduced by the Danish mathematician Thomas Fineke in 1583.
d
the chord cut by the lines will gradually
decrease, i.e., the two points of intersection of
the line and the circle are coming closer and
he
closer [see Fig. 10.3(ii)]. In one case, it
becomes zero on one side of the secant and in
another case, it becomes zero on the other side
of the secant. See the positions P′Q′ and P′′Q′′
is
of the secant in Fig. 10.3 (ii). These are the
tangents to the circle parallel to the given secant
PQ. This also helps you to see that there cannot Fig. 10.3 (ii)
bl
be more than two tangents parallel to a given
secant.
pu
This activity also establishes, what you must have observed, while doing
Activity 1, namely, a tangent is the secant when both of the end points of the
corresponding chord coincide.
be T
The common point of the tangent and the circle is called the point of contact
re
[the point A in Fig. 10.1 (iii)]and the tangent is said to touch the circle at the
o R
common point.
Now look around you. Have you seen a bicycle
tt E
d
circle). Therefore, OQ is longer than the radius
OP of the circle. That is,
he
OQ > OP.
Since this happens for every point on the
line XY except the point P, OP is the
shortest of all the distances of the point O to the
is
points of XY. So OP is perpendicular to XY.
(as shown in Theorem A1.7.) Fig. 10.5
bl
Remarks :
1. By theorem above, we can also conclude that at any point on a circle there can be
pu
one and only one tangent.
2. The line containing the radius through the point of contact is also sometimes called
be T
EXERCISE 10.1
o R
4. Draw a circle and two lines parallel to a given line such that one is a tangent and the
other, a secant to the circle.
d
two points. So, it is not possible to draw any
tangent to a circle through a point inside it
he
[see Fig. 10.6 (i)].
Next take a point P on the circle and draw
tangents through this point. You have already (i)
observed that there is only one tangent to the
is
circle at such a point [see Fig. 10.6 (ii)].
Finally, take a point P outside the circle and
bl
try to draw tangents to the circle from this point.
What do you observe? You will find that you
can draw exactly two tangents to the circle
pu
through this point [see Fig. 10.6 (iii)].
We can summarise these facts as follows:
be T
d
PQ, PR on the circle from P (see Fig. 10.7). We
are required to prove that PQ = PR.
he
For this, we join OP, OQ and OR. Then
∠ OQP and ∠ ORP are right angles, because
these are angles between the radii and tangents,
and according to Theorem 10.1 they are right Fig. 10.7
is
angles. Now in right triangles OQP and ORP,
OQ = OR (Radii of the same circle)
OP = OP (Common)
bl
Therefore, Δ OQP ≅ Δ ORP (RHS)
This gives PQ = PR (CPCT)
pu
Remarks :
be T
1. The theorem can also be proved by using the Pythagoras Theorem as follows:
re
PQ2 = OP2 – OQ2 = OP2 – OR 2 = PR2 (As OQ = OR)
o R
i.e., the centre lies on the bisector of the angle between the two tangents.
Let us take some examples.
C
Now AB is a chord of the circle C1 and OP ⊥ AB. Therefore, OP is the bisector of the
chord AB, as the perpendicular from the centre bisects the chord,
i.e., AP = BP
Example 2 : Two tangents TP and TQ are drawn
d
to a circle with centre O from an external point T.
Prove that ∠ PTQ = 2 ∠ OPQ.
he
Solution : We are given a circle with centre O,
an external point T and two tangents TP and TQ
to the circle, where P, Q are the points of contact
(see Fig. 10.9). We need to prove that
is
∠ PTQ = 2 ∠ OPQ Fig. 10.9
bl
Let ∠ PTQ = θ
⎛ 1 ⎞
o R
1 1
θ = ∠ PTQ
=
2 2
∠ PTQ = 2 ∠ OPQ
C
This gives
d
TP RP TP 4 20
This gives = , i.e., = or TP = cm.
PO RO 5 3 3
he
Note : TP can also be found by using the Pythagoras Theorem, as follows:
Let TP = x and TR = y. Then
x2 = y2 + 16 (Taking right Δ PRT) (1)
is
x + 5 = (y + 3)
2 2 2 (Taking right Δ OPT) (2)
Subtracting (1) from (2), we get
bl
32 16
25 = 6y – 7 or y = =
6 3
2
⎛ 16 ⎞ 16 16 × 25
pu
Therefore, x = ⎜ ⎟ + 16 = (16 + 9) =
2
[From (1)]
⎝3 ⎠ 9 9
20
be T
or x=
3
re
o R
EXERCISE 10.2
In Q.1 to 3, choose the correct option and give justification.
tt E
1. From a point Q, the length of the tangent to a circle is 24 cm and the distance of Q from
the centre is 25 cm. The radius of the circle is
C
(A) 7 cm (B) 12 cm
(C) 15 cm (D) 24.5 cm
no N
4. Prove that the tangents drawn at the ends of a diameter of a circle are parallel.
5. Prove that the perpendicular at the point of contact to the tangent to a circle passes
through the centre.
6. The length of a tangent from a point A at distance 5 cm from the centre of the circle is 4
d
cm. Find the radius of the circle.
7. Two concentric circles are of radii 5 cm and 3 cm. Find the length of the chord of the
he
larger circle which touches the smaller circle.
8. A quadrilateral ABCD is drawn to circumscribe a circle (see Fig. 10.12). Prove that
AB + CD = AD + BC
is
bl
pu
be T
9. In Fig. 10.13, XY and X′Y′ are two parallel tangents to a circle with centre O and
another tangent AB with point of contact C intersecting XY at A and X′Y′ at B. Prove
that ∠ AOB = 90°.
tt E
10. Prove that the angle between the two tangents drawn from an external point to a circle
is supplementary to the angle subtended by the line-segment joining the points of
contact at the centre.
C
10.4 Summary
In this chapter, you have studied the following points :
1. The meaning of a tangent to a circle.
2. The tangent to a circle is perpendicular to the radius through the point of contact.
d
3. The lengths of the two tangents from an external point to a circle are equal.
he
is
bl
pu
be T
re
o R
tt E
C
no N
©
d
he
CONSTRUCTIONS 11
is
11.1 Introduction
bl
In Class IX, you have done certain constructions using a straight edge (ruler) and a
compass, e.g., bisecting an angle, drawing the perpendicular bisector of a line segment,
some constructions of triangles etc. and also gave their justifications. In this chapter,
pu
we shall study some more constructions by using the knowledge of the earlier
constructions. You would also be expected to give the mathematical reasoning behind
be T
Suppose a line segment is given and you have to divide it in a given ratio, say 3 : 2. You
may do it by measuring the length and then marking a point on it that divides it in the
given ratio. But suppose you do not have any way of measuring it precisely, how
tt E
would you find the point? We give below two ways for finding such a point.
Construction 11.1 : To divide a line segment in a given ratio.
C
Given a line segment AB, we want to divide it in the ratio m : n, where both m and
n are positive integers. To help you to understand it, we shall take m = 3 and n = 2.
no N
Steps of Construction :
1. Draw any ray AX, making an acute angle with AB.
2. Locate 5 (= m + n) points A1, A2, A 3, A4 and
©
A5 on AX so that AA 1 = A1 A2 = A2 A3 = A3 A4
= A4 A5.
3. Join BA5.
4. Through the point A3 (m = 3), draw a line
parallel to A5 B (by making an angle equal to
∠ AA5B) at A3 intersecting AB at the point C
(see Fig. 11.1). Then, AC : CB = 3 : 2. Fig. 11.1
AA3 AC
= (By the Basic Proportionality Theorem)
d
A3A5 CB
he
AA3 3 AC 3 .
By construction, = ⋅ Therefore, =
A3A5 2 CB 2
This shows that C divides AB in the ratio 3 : 2.
is
Alternative Method
Steps of Construction :
1. Draw any ray AX making an acute angle with AB. Fig. 11.2
bl
2. Draw a ray BY parallel to AX by making ∠ ABY equal to ∠ BAX.
3. Locate the points A1, A 2, A3 (m = 3) on AX and B1, B 2 (n = 2) on BY such that
pu
AA1 = A1A2 = A2A3 = BB 1 = B1B 2.
4. Join A3 B2. Let it intersect AB at a point C (see Fig. 11.2).
Then AC : CB = 3 : 2.
be T
AA3 AC
Then = .
BB 2 BC
tt E
AA3 3 , AC 3
Since by construction, = therefore, = ⋅
BB2 2 BC 2
C
In fact, the methods given above work for dividing the line segment in any ratio.
We now use the idea of the construction above for constructing a triangle similar
to a given triangle whose sides are in a given ratio with the corresponding sides of the
no N
given triangle.
Construction 11.2 : To construct a triangle similar to a given triangle as per
given scale factor.
©
Example 1 : Construct a triangle similar to a given triangle ABC with its sides equal
3 3
to of the corresponding sides of the triangle ABC (i.e., of scale factor ).
4 4
d
Solution : Given a triangle ABC, we are required to construct another triangle whose
3
sides are of the corresponding sides of the triangle ABC.
he
4
Steps of Construction :
1. Draw any ray BX making an acute angle
with BC on the side opposite to the vertex
is
A.
3
2. Locate 4 (the greater of 3 and 4 in )
4
bl
points B 1, B2, B3 and B4 on BX so that
BB1 = B1 B2 = B2 B3 = B3B 4.
pu
3. Join B 4C and draw a line through B3 (the
3rd point, 3 being smaller of 3 and 4 in
3
be T
Let us now see how this construction gives the required triangle.
BC′ 3
C
By Construction 11.1, = ⋅
C′C 1
BC BC ′ + C′C C′C BC′
no N
1 4 3
Therefore, = =1+ = 1 + = , i.e., = .
BC′ BC′ BC′ 3 3 BC 4
Also C′A′ is parallel to CA. Therefore, Δ A′BC′ ~ Δ ABC. (Why ?)
©
Solution : Given a triangle ABC, we are required to construct a triangle whose sides
5
are of the corresponding sides of Δ ABC.
3
d
Steps of Construction :
1. Draw any ray BX making an acute angle with BC on the side opposite to the
he
vertex A.
5
2. Locate 5 points (the greater of 5 and 3 in ) B1 , B2 , B3, B4 and B5 on BX so that
3
BB1 = B1B2 = B2 B3 = B3B 4 = B4B 5.
is
5
3. Join B3(the 3rd point, 3 being smaller of 3 and 5 in ) to C and draw a line through
3
B5 parallel to B3C, intersecting the extended line segment BC at C′.
bl
4. Draw a line through C′ parallel to CA
intersecting the extended line segment BA at
A′ (see Fig. 11.4).
pu
Then A′BC′ is the required triangle.
For justification of the construction, note that
be T
AB AC BC
Therefore, = = ⋅
A′B A′C′ BC′
tt E
BC BB 3 3 ,
But, = =
BC′ BB5 5
C
Fig. 11.4
BC 3 AB AC BC 3
Remark : In Examples 1 and 2, you could take a ray making an acute angle with AB
or AC and proceed similarly.
©
EXERCISE 11.1
In each of the following, give the justification of the construction also:
1. Draw a line segment of length 7.6 cm and divide it in the ratio 5 : 8. Measure the two
parts.
2. Construct a triangle of sides 4 cm, 5 cm and 6 cm and then a triangle similar to it whose
2
sides are of the corresponding sides of the first triangle.
3
3. Construct a triangle with sides 5 cm, 6 cm and 7 cm and then another triangle whose
d
7
sides are of the corresponding sides of the first triangle.
he
5
4. Construct an isosceles triangle whose base is 8 cm and altitude 4 cm and then another
1
triangle whose sides are 1 times the corresponding sides of the isosceles triangle.
2
is
5. Draw a triangle ABC with side BC = 6 cm, AB = 5 cm and ∠ ABC = 60°. Then construct
3
a triangle whose sides are of the corresponding sides of the triangle ABC.
bl
4
6. Draw a triangle ABC with side BC = 7 cm, ∠ B = 45°, ∠ A = 105°. Then, construct a
pu 4
triangle whose sides are times the corresponding sides of Δ ABC.
3
7. Draw a right triangle in which the sides (other than hypotenuse) are of lengths 4 cm and
be T
3 cm. Then construct another triangle whose sides are 5 times the corresponding sides
re
3
o R
You have already studied in the previous chapter that if a point lies inside a circle,
there cannot be a tangent to the circle through this point. However, if a point lies on the
C
circle, then there is only one tangent to the circle at this point and it is perpendicular to
the radius through this point. Therefore, if you want to draw a tangent at a point of a
circle, simply draw the radius through this point and draw a line perpendicular to this
no N
radius through this point and this will be the required tangent at the point.
You have also seen that if the point lies outside the circle, there will be two
tangents to the circle from this point.
©
Construction 11.3 : To construct the tangents to a circle from a point outside it.
We are given a circle with centre O and a point P outside it. We have to construct
the two tangents from P to the circle.
Steps of Construction:
1. Join PO and bisect it. Let M be the mid-
point of PO.
2. Taking M as centre and MO as radius, draw
d
a circle. Let it intersect the given circle at
the points Q and R.
he
3. Join PQ and PR.
Then PQ and PR are the required two
tangents (see Fig. 11.5).
is
Now let us see how this construction works.
Join OQ. Then ∠ PQO is an angle in the
semicircle and, therefore, Fig. 11.5
bl
∠ PQO = 90°
Can we say that PQ ⊥ OQ?
pu
Since, OQ is a radius of the given circle, PQ has to be a tangent to the circle. Similarly,
PR is also a tangent to the circle.
be T
Note : If centre of the circle is not given, you may locate its centre first by taking any
re
two non-parallel chords and then finding the point of intersection of their perpendicular
o R
EXERCISE 11.2
In each of the following, give also the justification of the construction:
C
1. Draw a circle of radius 6 cm. From a point 10 cm away from its centre, construct the pair
of tangents to the circle and measure their lengths.
no N
points P and Q.
4. Draw a pair of tangents to a circle of radius 5 cm which are inclined to each other at an
angle of 60°.
5. Draw a line segment AB of length 8 cm. Taking A as centre, draw a circle of radius 4 cm
and taking B as centre, draw another circle of radius 3 cm. Construct tangents to each
circle from the centre of the other circle.
d
of tangents from this point to the circle.
11.4 Summary
he
In this chapter, you have learnt how to do the following constructions:
1. To divide a line segment in a given ratio.
2. To construct a triangle similar to a given triangle as per a given scale factor which
is
may be less than 1 or greater than 1.
3. To construct the pair of tangents from an external point to a circle.
bl
pu
A NOTE TO THE READER
Construction of a quadrilateral (or a polygon) similar to a given quadrilateral
be T
(or a polygon) with a given scale factor can also be done following the
re
similar steps as used in Examples 1 and 2 of Construction 11.2.
o R
tt E
C
no N
©
e
12
h
AREAS RELATED TO CIRCLES
pu T
is
re R
12.1 Introduction
bl
You are already familiar with some methods of finding perimeters and areas of simple
E
plane figures such as rectangles, squares, parallelograms, triangles and circles from
your earlier classes. Many objects that we come across in our daily life are related to
be C
the circular shape in some form or the other. Cycle wheels, wheel barrow (thela),
dartboard, round cake, papad, drain cover, various designs, bangles, brooches, circular
paths, washers, flower beds, etc. are some examples of such objects (see Fig. 12.1).
o N
So, the problem of finding perimeters and areas related to circular figures is of great
practical importance. In this chapter, we shall begin our discussion with a review of
the concepts of perimeter (circumference) and area of a circle and apply this knowledge
©
in finding the areas of two special ‘parts’ of a circular region (or briefly of a circle)
known as sector and segment. We shall also see how to find the areas of some
combinations of plane figures involving circles or their parts.
tt
no
Fig. 12.1
e
circumference
= π
diameter
h
or, circumference = π × diameter
pu T
= π × 2r (where r is the radius of the circle)
is
re R = 2πr
The great Indian mathematician Aryabhatta (C.E. 476 – 550) gave an approximate
bl
62832 ,
value of π. He stated that π =
E
which is nearly equal to 3.1416. It is also
20000
interesting to note that using an identity of the great mathematical genius Srinivas
be C
You may also recall that area of a circle is πr2, where r is the radius of the circle.
Recall that you have verified it in Class VII, by cutting a circle into a number of
sectors and rearranging them as shown in Fig. 12.2.
tt
no
Fig 12.2
1
You can see that the shape in Fig. 12.2 (ii) is nearly a rectangle of length × 2 π r
2
1
and breadth r. This suggests that the area of the circle = × 2πr × r = πr2. Let us
2
recall the concepts learnt in earlier classes, through an example.
Example 1 : The cost of fencing a circular field at the rate of ` 24 per metre is
e
` 5280. The field is to be ploughed at the rate of ` 0.50 per m2. Find the cost of
22
ploughing the field (Take π = ).
h
7
Total cost 5280
= 220
pu T
Solution : Length of the fence (in metres) = =
Rate 24
is
So, circumference of the field = 220 m
re R
Therefore, if r metres is the radius of the field, then
bl
2πr = 220
22
E
or, 2× × r = 220
7
220 × 7
or, r= = 35
be C
2 × 22
i.e., radius of the field is 35 m.
22
Therefore, area of the field = πr2 =× 35 × 35 m2 = 22 × 5 × 35 m2
7
o N
EXERCISE 12.1
22
Unless stated otherwise, use π = .
7
1. The radii of two circles are 19 cm and 9 cm respectively.
Find the radius of the circle which has circumference equal
to the sum of the circumferences of the two circles.
2. The radii of two circles are 8 cm and 6 cm respectively. Find
tt
the radius of the circle having area equal to the sum of the
areas of the two circles.
3. Fig. 12.3 depicts an archery target marked with its five
scoring regions from the centre outwards as Gold, Red, Blue,
no
4. The wheels of a car are of diameter 80 cm each. How many complete revolutions does
each wheel make in 10 minutes when the car is travelling at a speed of 66 km per hour?
5. Tick the correct answer in the following and justify your choice : If the perimeter and the
area of a circle are numerically equal, then the radius of the circle is
(A) 2 units (B) π units (C) 4 units (D) 7 units
e
12.3 Areas of Sector and Segment of a Circle
You have already come across the terms sector and
h
segment of a circle in your earlier classes. Recall
pu T
that the portion (or part) of the circular region enclosed
is
by two radii and the corresponding arc is called a
sector of the circle and the portion (or part) of the
re R
circular region enclosed between a chord and the
bl
corresponding arc is called a segment of the circle.
E
Thus, in Fig. 12.4, shaded region OAPB is a sector
Fig. 12.4
of the circle with centre O. ∠ AOB is called the
angle of the sector. Note that in this figure, unshaded region OAQB is also a sector of
be C
the circle. For obvious reasons, OAPB is called the minor sector and
OAQB is called the major sector. You can also see that angle of the major sector is
360° – ∠ AOB.
o N
e
πr 2
sector = ⋅
360
h
Therefore, when the degree measure of the angle at the centre is θ, area of the
pu T
πr 2 θ
is
sector = ×θ = × πr 2 .
re R 360 360
Thus, we obtain the following relation (or formula) for area of a sector of a
bl
circle:
E
θ
Area of the sector of angle θ = × πr 2 ,
360
be C
where r is the radius of the circle and θ the angle of the sector in degrees.
Now, a natural question arises : Can we find
the length of the arc APB corresponding to this
o N
θ
× πr 2 – area of Δ OAB
=
360
no
Note : From Fig. 12.6 and Fig. 12.7 respectively, you can observe that :
Area of the major sector OAQB = πr2 – Area of the minor sector OAPB
and Area of major segment AQB = πr2 – Area of the minor segment APB
Let us now take some examples to understand these concepts (or results).
e
θ
Area of the sector = × πr 2
360
h
30
× 3.14 × 4 × 4 cm 2
pu T
=
360 Fig. 12.8
is
12.56
cm 2 = 4.19cm 2 (approx.)
re R =
3
bl
Area of the corresponding major sector
E
= πr2 – area of sector OAPB
be C
(360 – θ)
Alternatively, area of the major sector = × πr 2
360
⎛ 360 − 30 ⎞
⎟ × 3.14 × 16 cm
2
= ⎜
©
⎝ 360 ⎠
330
= × 3.14 × 16cm 2 = 46.05 cm 2
360
= 46.1 cm2 (approx.)
22
∠ AOB = 120°. (Use π = )
7
no
Fig. 12.9
e
Note that OA = OB. Therefore, by RHS congruence, Δ AMO ≅ Δ BMO.
h
1
So, M is the mid-point of AB and ∠ AOM = ∠ BOM = × 120° = 60° .
pu T
2
is
Letre R OM = x cm
OM
So, from Δ OMA,
bl
= cos 60°
OA
E
x 1 ⎛ 1⎞
or, = ⎜ cos 60° = ⎟ Fig. 12.10
21 2 ⎝ 2⎠
be C
21
or, x=
2
o N
21
So, OM = cm
2
AM 3
Also, = sin 60° =
OA
©
2
21 3
So, AM = cm
2
2 × 21 3
Therefore, AB = 2 AM = cm = 21 3 cm
2
1 1 21
So, area of Δ OAB = AB × OM = × 21 3 × cm 2
2 2 2
441
3 cm 2
tt
= (3)
4
⎛ 441 ⎞
Therefore, area of the segment AYB = ⎜ 462 − 3 ⎟ cm 2 [From (1), (2) and (3)]
no
⎝ 4 ⎠
21
= (88 – 21 3)cm 2
4
EXERCISE 12.2
22
Unless stated otherwise, use π = .
7
1. Find the area of a sector of a circle with radius 6 cm if angle of the sector is 60°.
2. Find the area of a quadrant of a circle whose circumference is 22 cm.
e
3. The length of the minute hand of a clock is 14 cm. Find the area swept by the minute
hand in 5 minutes.
h
4. A chord of a circle of radius 10 cm subtends a right angle at the centre. Find the area of
pu T
the corresponding : (i) minor segment (ii) major sector. (Use π = 3.14)
is
5. In a circle of radius 21 cm, an arc subtends an angle of 60° at the centre. Find:
re R (i) the length of the arc (ii) area of the sector formed by the arc
bl
(iii) area of the segment formed by the corresponding chord
E
6. A chord of a circle of radius 15 cm subtends an angle of 60° at the centre. Find the areas
of the corresponding minor and major segments of the circle.
(Use π = 3.14 and 3 = 1.73)
be C
Fig. 12.12
e
an angle of 115°. Find the total area cleaned at each
sweep of the blades. Fig. 12.13
h
12. To warn ships for underwater rocks, a lighthouse
pu T
spreads a red coloured light over a sector of angle
is
80° to a distance of 16.5 km. Find the area of the sea
re R
over which the ships are warned. (Use π = 3.14)
bl
13. A round table cover has six equal designs as shown
in Fig. 12.14. If the radius of the cover is 28 cm, find
E
the cost of making the designs at the rate of
` 0.35 per cm2. (Use 3 = 1.7)
be C
p p p p
(A) × 2πR (B) × π R2 (C) × 2πR (D) × 2 π R2
180 180 360 720
So far, we have calculated the areas of different figures separately. Let us now try to
calculate the areas of some combinations of plane figures. We come across these
types of figures in our daily life and also in the form of various interesting designs.
Flower beds, drain covers, window designs, designs on table covers, are some of such
examples. We illustrate the process of calculating areas of these figures through some
examples.
or, 2x2 = 56 × 56
or, x2 = 28 × 56 (2)
e
90 1
Now, area of sector OAB = × π x2 = × π x2
h
360 4
pu T
1 22
× × 28 × 56 m 2
is
= [From (2)] (3)
re R 4 7
bl
Also, area of Δ OAB = × 56 × 56 m 2 (∠ AOB = 90°) (4)
4
E
⎛ 1 22 1 ⎞
So, area of flower bed AB = ⎜ × × 28 × 56 − × 56 × 56 ⎟ m 2
⎝4 7 ⎠
be C
4
[From (3) and (4)]
1 ⎛ 22 ⎞
o N
= × 28 × 56 ⎜ − 2 ⎟ m2
4 ⎝ 7 ⎠
1 8
= × 28 × 56 × m 2 (5)
4 7
©
4 7⎠
⎛ 2 2⎞ 2
= 28 × 56 ⎜ 2 + + ⎟ m
⎝ 7 7⎠
no
18 2
= 28 × 56 × m = 4032m2
7
Alternative Solution :
Total area = Area of sector OAB + Area of sector ODC
+ Area of Δ OAD + Area of Δ OBC
⎛ 90 22 90 22
= ⎜ × × 28 × 56 + × × 28 × 56
⎝ 360 7 360 7
e
1 1 ⎞
+ × 56 × 56 + × 56 × 56 ⎟ m 2
h
4 4 ⎠
pu T
is
1 ⎛ 22 22 ⎞
re R = × 28 × 56 ⎜ + +2+ 2 ⎟ m2
4 ⎝ 7 7 ⎠
bl
7 × 56
(22 + 22 + 14 + 14) m 2
E
=
7
= 56 × 72 m2 = 4032 m2
be C
14
©
7 Fig. 12.16
So, radius of each circle = cm
2
22 7 7
So, area of one circle = πr2 = × × cm2
7 2 2
tt
154 77
= cm = cm 2
4 2
77 2
no
Example 6 : Find the area of the shaded design in Fig. 12.17, where ABCD is a
square of side 10 cm and semicircles are drawn with each side of the square as
diameter. (Use π = 3.14)
h e
pu T
is
re R Fig. 12.17 Fig. 12.18
bl
Solution : Let us mark the four unshaded regions as I, II, III and IV (see Fig. 12.18).
E
Area of I + Area of III
= Area of ABCD – Areas of two semicircles of each of radius 5 cm
be C
⎛ 1 2⎞
= ⎜10 × 10 – 2 × × π × 5 ⎟ cm = (100 – 3.14 × 25) cm2
2
o N
⎝ 2 ⎠
= (100 – 78.5) cm2 = 21.5 cm2
Similarly, Area of II + Area of IV = 21.5 cm2
©
So, area of the shaded design = Area of ABCD – Area of (I + II + III + IV)
= (100 – 2 × 21.5) cm2 = (100 – 43) cm2 = 57 cm2
EXERCISE 12.3
22
Unless stated otherwise, use π = ⋅
7
1. Find the area of the shaded region in Fig. 12.19, if
tt
Fig. 12.19
2. Find the area of the shaded region in Fig. 12.20, if radii of the two concentric circles with
centre O are 7 cm and 14 cm respectively and ∠ AOC = 40°.
h e
pu T
is
Fig. 12.20 Fig. 12.21
re R
3. Find the area of the shaded region in Fig. 12.21, if ABCD is a square of side 14 cm and
bl
APD and BPC are semicircles.
4. Find the area of the shaded region in Fig. 12.22, where a circular arc of radius 6 cm has
E
been drawn with vertex O of an equilateral triangle OAB of side 12 cm as centre.
be C
o N
©
Fig. 12.24
h e
pu T
Fig. 12.25
is
8. Fig. 12.26 depicts a racing track whose left and right ends are semicircular.
re R
bl
E
be C
Fig. 12.26
o N
(i) the distance around the track along its inner edge
(ii) the area of the track.
9. In Fig. 12.27, AB and CD are two diameters of a
circle (with centre O) perpendicular to each other
and OD is the diameter of the smaller circle. If
Fig. 12.27
OA = 7 cm, find the area of the shaded region.
10. The area of an equilateral triangle ABC is 17320.5
tt
Fig. 12.28
11. On a square handkerchief, nine circular designs each of radius 7 cm are made
(see Fig. 12.29). Find the area of the remaining portion of the handkerchief.
h e
pu T
is
re R Fig. 12.29 Fig. 12.30
12. In Fig. 12.30, OACB is a quadrant of a circle with centre O and radius 3.5 cm. If OD = 2 cm,
bl
find the area of the
E
(i) quadrant OACB, (ii) shaded region.
13. In Fig. 12.31, a square OABC is inscribed in a quadrant OPBQ. If OA = 20 cm, find the
area of the shaded region. (Use π = 3.14)
be C
o N
©
Fig. 12.33
h e
Fig. 12.34
pu T
12.5 Summary
is
In this chapter, you have studied the following points :
re R
1. Circumference of a circle = 2 π r.
bl
2. Area of a circle = π r2.
E
3. Length of an arc of a sector of a circle with radius r and angle with degree measure θ is
θ
× 2 π r⋅
be C
360
θ
4. Area of a sector of a circle with radius r and angle with degrees measure θ is × π r 2⋅
o N
360
5. Area of segment of a circle
= Area of the corresponding sector – Area of the corresponding triangle.
tt ©
no
Fig. 13.1
In our day-to-day life, we come across a number of solids made up of combinations
of two or more of the basic solids as shown above.
You must have seen a truck with a
container fitted on its back (see Fig. 13.2),
carrying oil or water from one place to
another. Is it in the shape of any of the four
basic solids mentioned above? You may
guess that it is made of a cylinder with two
hemispheres as its ends.
Fig. 13.2
240 MATHEMATICS
Fig. 13.4
If we consider the surface of the newly formed object, we would be able to see
only the curved surfaces of the two hemispheres and the curved surface of the cylinder.
So, the total surface area of the new solid is the sum of the curved surface
areas of each of the individual parts. This gives,
TSA of new solid = CSA of one hemisphere + CSA of cylinder
+ CSA of other hemisphere
where TSA, CSA stand for ‘Total Surface Area’ and ‘Curved Surface Area’
respectively.
Let us now consider another situation. Suppose we are making a toy by putting
together a hemisphere and a cone. Let us see the steps that we would be going
through.
S URFACE A REAS AND VOLUMES 241
First, we would take a cone and a hemisphere and bring their flat faces together.
Here, of course, we would take the base radius of the cone equal to the radius of the
hemisphere, for the toy is to have a smooth surface. So, the steps would be as shown
in Fig. 13.5.
Fig. 13.5
At the end of our trial, we have got ourselves a nice round-bottomed toy. Now if
we want to find how much paint we would require to colour the surface of this toy,
what would we need to know? We would need to know the surface area of the toy,
which consists of the CSA of the hemisphere and the CSA of the cone.
So, we can say:
Total surface area of the toy = CSA of hemisphere + CSA of cone
Now, let us consider some examples.
Also, the height of the cone = height of the top – height (radius) of the hemispherical part
3.5
= 5 cm = 3.25 cm
2
2
3.5
So, the slant height of the cone (l ) = r h (3.25) cm = 3.7 cm (approx.)
2 2 2
2
22 3.5
Therefore, CSA of cone = πrl = 3.7 cm2
7 2
This gives the surface area of the top as
22 3.5 3.5 2 22 3.5
= 2 cm 3.7 cm2
7 2 2 7 2
22 3.5 11
= 3.5 3.7 cm 2 = (3.5 3.7) cm 2 39.6 cm 2 (approx.)
7 2 2
You may note that ‘total surface area of the top’ is not the sum of the total
surface areas of the cone and hemisphere.
22 4.2 4.2
= 150 cm2 cm
2
7 2 2
= (150 + 13.86) cm = 163.86 cm2
2
S URFACE A REAS AND VOLUMES 243
l= r 2 h2 = 2.5 2 62 cm = 6.5 cm
Here, the conical portion has its circular base resting on the base of the cylinder, but
the base of the cone is larger than the base of the cylinder. So, a part of the base of the
cone (a ring) is to be painted.
So, the area to be painted orange = CSA of the cone + base area of the cone
– base area of the cylinder
= πrl + πr2 – π(r′) 2
= π[(2.5 × 6.5) + (2.5)2 – (1.5)2] cm2
= π[20.25] cm2 = 3.14 × 20.25 cm2
= 63.585 cm 2
Now, the area to be painted yellow = CSA of the cylinder
+ area of one base of the cylinder
= 2πr′h′ + π(r′) 2
= πr′ (2h′ + r′)
= (3.14 × 1.5) (2 × 20 + 1.5) cm 2
= 4.71 × 41.5 cm 2
= 195.465 cm2
244 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 13.1
22
Unless stated otherwise, take π =
7
1. 2 cubes each of volume 64 cm3 are joined end to end. Find the surface area of the
resulting cuboid.
2. A vessel is in the form of a hollow hemisphere mounted by a hollow cylinder. The
diameter of the hemisphere is 14 cm and the total height of the vessel is 13 cm. Find the
inner surface area of the vessel.
3. A toy is in the form of a cone of radius 3.5 cm mounted on a hemisphere of same radius.
The total height of the toy is 15.5 cm. Find the total surface area of the toy.
4. A cubical block of side 7 cm is surmounted by a hemisphere. What is the greatest
diameter the hemisphere can have? Find the surface area of the solid.
5. A hemispherical depression is cut out from one face of a cubical wooden block such
that the diameter l of the hemisphere is equal to the edge of the cube. Determine the
surface area of the remaining solid.
6. A medicine capsule is in the shape of a
cylinder with two hemispheres stuck to each
of its ends (see Fig. 13.10). The length of
the entire capsule is 14 mm and the diameter
of the capsule is 5 mm. Find its surface area. Fig. 13.10
S URFACE A REAS AND VOLUMES 245
7. A tent is in the shape of a cylinder surmounted by a conical top. If the height and
diameter of the cylindrical part are 2.1 m and 4 m respectively, and the slant height of the
top is 2.8 m, find the area of the canvas used for making the tent. Also, find the cost of
the canvas of the tent at the rate of Rs 500 per m2. (Note that the base of the tent will not
be covered with canvas.)
8. From a solid cylinder whose height is 2.4 cm and diameter 1.4 cm, a conical cavity of the
same height and same diameter is hollowed out. Find the total surface area of the
remaining solid to the nearest cm2.
9. A wooden article was made by scooping
out a hemisphere from each end of a solid
cylinder, as shown in Fig. 13.11. If the
height of the cylinder is 10 cm, and its
base is of radius 3.5 cm, find the total
surface area of the article.
In the previous section, we have discussed how to find the surface area of solids made
up of a combination of two basic solids. Here, we shall see how to calculate their
volumes. It may be noted that in calculating the surface area, we have not added the
surface areas of the two constituents, because some part of the surface area disappeared
in the process of joining them. However, this will not be the case when we calculate
the volume. The volume of the solid formed by joining two basic solids will actually be
the sum of the volumes of the constituents, as we see in the examples below.
Solution : The volume of air inside the shed (when there are no people or machinery)
is given by the volume of air inside the cuboid and inside the half cylinder, taken
together.
Now, the length, breadth and height of the cuboid are 15 m, 7 m and 8 m, respectively.
Also, the diameter of the half cylinder is 7 m and its height is 15 m.
1
So, the required volume = volume of the cuboid + volume of the cylinder
2
1 22 7 7
= 15 7 8 15 m 3 = 1128.75 m 3
2 7 2 2
Next, the total space occupied by the machinery = 300 m3
And the total space occupied by the workers = 20 × 0.08 m 3 = 1.6 m3
Therefore, the volume of the air, when there are machinery and workers
= 1128.75 – (300.00 + 1.60) = 827.15 m3
Example 6 : A juice seller was serving his
customers using glasses as shown in Fig. 13.13.
The inner diameter of the cylindrical glass was
5 cm, but the bottom of the glass had a
hemispherical raised portion which reduced the
capacity of the glass. If the height of a glass
was 10 cm, find the apparent capacity of the
glass and its actual capacity. (Use π = 3.14.) Fig. 13.13
Solution : Since the inner diameter of the glass = 5 cm and height = 10 cm,
the apparent capacity of the glass = πr 2 h
= 3.14 × 2.5 × 2.5 × 10 cm 3 = 196.25 cm3
But the actual capacity of the glass is less by the volume of the hemisphere at the
base of the glass.
2 2
πr 3 = 3.14 2.5 2.5 2.5 cm = 32.71 cm 3
3
i.e., it is less by
3 3
So, the actual capacity of the glass = apparent capacity of glass – volume of the
hemisphere
= (196.25 – 32.71) cm3
= 163.54 cm3
S URFACE A REAS AND VOLUMES 247
EXERCISE 13.2
22
Unless stated otherwise, take π = .
7
1 . A solid is in the shape of a cone standing on a hemisphere with both their radii being
equal to 1 cm and the height of the cone is equal to its radius. Find the volume of the solid
in terms of π.
2. Rachel, an engineering student, was asked to make a model shaped like a cylinder with
two cones attached at its two ends by using a thin aluminium sheet. The diameter of the
model is 3 cm and its length is 12 cm. If each cone has a height of 2 cm, find the volume
of air contained in the model that Rachel made. (Assume the outer and inner dimensions
of the model to be nearly the same.)
248 MATHEMATICS
Fig. 13.17
S URFACE A REAS AND VOLUMES 249
How are they made? If you want a candle of any special shape, you will have to
heat the wax in a metal container till it becomes completely liquid. Then you will have to
pour it into another container which has the special shape that you want. For example,
take a candle in the shape of a solid cylinder, melt it and pour whole of the molten wax
into another container shaped like a rabbit. On cooling, you will obtain a candle in the
shape of the rabbit. The volume of the new candle will be the same as the volume of
the earlier candle. This is what we
have to remember when we come
across objects which are converted
from one shape to another, or when
a liquid which originally filled one
container of a particular shape is
poured into another container of a
different shape or size, as you see in Fig. 13.18
Fig 13.18.
To understand what has been discussed, let us consider some examples.
So, r= 3 ×2=6
Therefore, the radius of the sphere is 6 cm.
Example 9 : Selvi’s house has an overhead tank in the shape of a cylinder. This
is filled by pumping water from a sump (an underground tank) which is in the
shape of a cuboid. The sump has dimensions 1.57 m × 1.44 m × 95cm. The
overhead tank has its radius 60 cm and height 95 cm. Find the height of the water
left in the sump after the overhead tank has been completely filled with water
from the sump which had been full. Compare the capacity of the tank with that of
the sump. (Use π = 3.14)
250 MATHEMATICS
Solution : The volume of water in the overhead tank equals the volume of the water
removed from the sump.
Now, the volume of water in the overhead tank (cylinder) = πr2h
= 3.14 × 0.6 × 0.6 × 0.95 m 3
The volume of water in the sump when full = l × b × h = 1.57 × 1.44 × 0.95 m3
The volume of water left in the sump after filling the tank
= [(1.57 × 1.44 × 0.95) – (3.14 × 0.6 × 0.6 × 0.95)] m3 = (1.57 × 0.6 × 0.6 × 0.95 × 2) m3
volume of water left in the sump
So, the height of the water left in the sump =
lb
1.57 0.6 0.6 0.95 2
= m
1.57 1.44
= 0.475 m = 47.5 cm
3
Solution : Radius of the hemispherical tank = m
2
3
2 22 3 99 3
Volume of the tank = m3 = m
3 7 2 14
1 99 3 99
So, the volume of the water to be emptied = m = 1000 litres
2 14 28
99000
= litres
28
25 99000
Since, litres of water is emptied in 1 second, litres of water will be emptied
7 28
99000 7
in seconds, i.e., in 16.5 minutes.
28 25
EXERCISE 13.3
22
Take π = , unless stated otherwise.
7
1. A metallic sphere of radius 4.2 cm is melted and recast into the shape of a cylinder of
radius 6 cm. Find the height of the cylinder.
2. Metallic spheres of radii 6 cm, 8 cm and 10 cm, respectively, are melted to form a single
solid sphere. Find the radius of the resulting sphere.
3. A 20 m deep well with diameter 7 m is dug and the earth from digging is evenly spread out
to form a platform 22 m by 14 m. Find the height of the platform.
4. A well of diameter 3 m is dug 14 m deep. The earth taken out of it has been spread evenly
all around it in the shape of a circular ring of width 4 m to form an embankment. Find the
height of the embankment.
5. A container shaped like a right circular cylinder having diameter 12 cm and height 15 cm
is full of ice cream. The ice cream is to be filled into cones of height 12 cm and diameter
6 cm, having a hemispherical shape on the top. Find the number of such cones which can
be filled with ice cream.
6. How many silver coins, 1.75 cm in diameter and of thickness 2 mm, must be melted to form
a cuboid of dimensions 5.5 cm × 10 cm × 3.5 cm?
252 MATHEMATICS
7. A cylindrical bucket, 32 cm high and with radius of base 18 cm, is filled with sand. This
bucket is emptied on the ground and a conical heap of sand is formed. If the height of the
conical heap is 24 cm, find the radius and slant height of the heap.
8. Water in a canal, 6 m wide and 1.5 m deep, is flowing with a speed of 10 km/h. How much
area will it irrigate in 30 minutes, if 8 cm of standing water is needed?
9. A farmer connects a pipe of internal diameter 20 cm from a canal into a cylindrical tank in
her field, which is 10 m in diameter and 2 m deep. If water flows through the pipe at the
rate of 3 km/h, in how much time will the tank be filled?
Fig. 13.20
*‘Frustum’ is a latin word meaning ‘piece cut off’, and its plural is ‘frusta’.
S URFACE A REAS AND VOLUMES 253
How can we find the surface area and volume of a frustum of a cone? Let
us explain it through an example.
h1 28 4
= (2)
h2 7 1
1 22 1 22
= (28) 2 (60) (7) 2 (15) cm 3 48510 cm 3
3 7 3 7
The respective slant height l2 and l1 of the cones OCD and OAB are given
by
l2 = (7) 2 (15) 2 16.55 cm (approx.)
22 22 2 2
= 5461.5 cm2 + (28) 2 cm 2 (7) cm
7 7
= 5461.5 cm2 + 2464 cm2 + 154 cm 2 = 8079.5 cm2 .
Let h be the height, l the slant height and r1 and r2 the radii of the ends
(r1 > r2 ) of the frustum of a cone. Then we can directly find the volume, the
curved surace area and the total surface area of frustum by using the formulae
given below :
1
(i) Volume of the frustum of the cone = h( r12 r22 r1r2 ) .
3
(ii) the curved surface area of the frustum of the cone = π(r1 + r2)l
where l = h2 ( r1 r2 ) 2 .
(iii) Total surface area of the frustum of the cone = πl (r1 + r2) + πr12 + πr22,
where l = h2 ( r1 r2 ) 2 .
These formulae can be derived using the idea of similarity of triangles but we
shall not be doing derivations here.
Let us solve Example 12, using these formulae :
h 2 r1 r2
2
(ii) We have l= (45) 2 (28 7) 2 cm
22
= π(r 1 + r2) l = (28 7) (49.65) = 5461.5 cm2
7
(iii) Total curved surface area of the frustum
= r1 r2 l r12 r22
22 22 2
= 5461.5 (28) 2 (7) cm2 = 8079.5 cm 2
7 7
Let us apply these formulae in some examples.
where r1 is the radius of the larger base and r2 is the radius of the smaller base.
1 22 35 2 30 2 35 30 3
= 14 cm = 11641.7 cm3.
3 7 2 2 2 2
It is given that 1 cm3 of molasses has mass 1.2g. So, the mass of the molasses that can
be poured into each mould = (11641.7 × 1.2) g
= 342 10 2 35.44 cm
The area of metallic sheet used = curved surface area of frustum of cone
+ area of circular base
+ curved surface area of cylinder
22
= (1240.4 156.25 150) cm 2
7
= 4860.9 cm2
S URFACE A REAS AND VOLUMES 257
Now, the volume of water that the bucket can hold (also, known as the capacity
of the bucket)
h
= (r12 r22 r1r2 )
3
22 34
= [(22.5) 2 (12.5) 2 22.5 12.5] cm3
7 3
22 34
= 943.75 = 33615.48 cm3
7 3
= 33.62 litres (approx.)
EXERCISE 13.4
22
Use π = unless stated otherwise.
7
1. A drinking glass is in the shape of a frustum of a
cone of height 14 cm. The diameters of its two
circular ends are 4 cm and 2 cm. Find the capacity of
the glass.
2. The slant height of a frustum of a cone is 4 cm and
the perimeters (circumference) of its circular ends
are 18 cm and 6 cm. Find the curved surface area of
the frustum.
3. A fez, the cap used by the Turks, is shaped like the
frustum of a cone (see Fig. 13.24). If its radius on the
open side is 10 cm, radius at the upper base is 4 cm
and its slant height is 15 cm, find the area of material Fig. 13.24
used for making it.
4. A container, opened from the top and made up of a metal sheet, is in the form of a
frustum of a cone of height 16 cm with radii of its lower and upper ends as 8 cm and 20
cm, respectively. Find the cost of the milk which can completely fill the container, at the
rate of ` 20 per litre. Also find the cost of metal sheet used to make the container, if it
costs ` 8 per 100 cm2. (Take π = 3.14)
5. A metallic right circular cone 20 cm high and whose vertical angle is 60° is cut into two
parts at the middle of its height by a plane parallel to its base. If the frustum so obtained
1
be drawn into a wire of diameter cm, find the length of the wire.
16
258 MATHEMATICS
13.6 Summary
In this chapter, you have studied the following points:
1. To determine the surface area of an object formed by combining any two of the basic
solids, namely, cuboid, cone, cylinder, sphere and hemisphere.
2. To find the volume of objects formed by combining any two of a cuboid, cone, cylinder,
sphere and hemisphere.
3. Given a right circular cone, which is sliced through by a plane parallel to its base, when
the smaller conical portion is removed, the resulting solid is called a Frustum of a Right
Circular Cone.
4. The formulae involving the frustum of a cone are:
h2 r1 r2 .
2
(ii) Curved surface area of a frustum of a cone = πl(r1 + r2) where l =
(iii) Total surface area of frustum of a cone = πl(r1 + r2) + π(r12 + r22) where
h = vertical height of the frustum, l = slant height of the frustum
r1 and r2 are radii of the two bases (ends) of the frustum.
260 MATHEMATICS
STATISTICS 14
14.1 Introduction
In Class IX, you have studied the classification of given data into ungrouped as well as
grouped frequency distributions. You have also learnt to represent the data pictorially
in the form of various graphs such as bar graphs, histograms (including those of varying
widths) and frequency polygons. In fact, you went a step further by studying certain
numerical representatives of the ungrouped data, also called measures of central
tendency, namely, mean, median and mode. In this chapter, we shall extend the study
of these three measures, i.e., mean, median and mode from ungrouped data to that of
grouped data. We shall also discuss the concept of cumulative frequency, the
cumulative frequency distribution and how to draw cumulative frequency curves, called
ogives.
fx
i 1
i i
x = n
f
i 1
i
fi xi
which, more briefly, is written as x = , if it is understood that i varies from
fi
1 to n.
Let us apply this formula to find the mean in the following example.
Marks obtained 10 20 36 40 50 56 60 70 72 80 88 92 95
( x i)
Number of 1 1 3 4 3 2 4 4 1 1 2 3 1
student ( fi)
Solution: Recall that to find the mean marks, we require the product of each xi with
the corresponding frequency fi. So, let us put them in a column as shown in Table 14.1.
Table 14.1
10 1 10
20 1 20
. 36 3 108
40 4 160
50 3 150
56 2 112
60 4 240
70 4 280
72 1 72
80 1 80
88 2 176
92 3 276
95 1 95
fi xi 1779
Now, x = = 59.3
fi 30
Table 14.2
Number of students 2 3 7 6 6 6
Now, for each class-interval, we require a point which would serve as the
representative of the whole class. It is assumed that the frequency of each class-
interval is centred around its mid-point. So the mid-point (or class mark) of each
class can be chosen to represent the observations falling in the class. Recall that we
find the mid-point of a class (or its class mark) by finding the average of its upper and
lower limits. That is,
Upper class limit + Lower class limit
Class mark =
2
10 25
With reference to Table 14.2, for the class 10 -25, the class mark is , i.e.,
2
17.5. Similarly, we can find the class marks of the remaining class intervals. We put
them in Table 14.3. These class marks serve as our xi’s. Now, in general, for the ith
class interval, we have the frequency fi corresponding to the class mark xi. We can
now proceed to compute the mean in the same manner as in Example 1.
STATISTICS 263
Table 14.3
10 - 25 2 17.5 35.0
25 - 40 3 32.5 97.5
40 - 55 7 47.5 332.5
55 - 70 6 62.5 375.0
70 - 85 6 77.5 465.0
85 - 100 6 92.5 555.0
Total Σ fi = 30 Σ fi xi = 1860.0
The sum of the values in the last column gives us Σ fi xi. So, the mean x of the
given data is given by
f i xi 1860.0
x = 62
fi 30
This new method of finding the mean is known as the Direct Method.
We observe that Tables 14.1 and 14.3 are using the same data and employing the
same formula for the calculation of the mean but the results obtained are different.
Can you think why this is so, and which one is more accurate? The difference in the
two values is because of the mid-point assumption in Table 14.3, 59.3 being the exact
mean, while 62 an approximate mean.
Sometimes when the numerical values of xi and fi are large, finding the product
of xi and fi becomes tedious and time consuming. So, for such situations, let us think of
a method of reducing these calculations.
We can do nothing with the fi’s, but we can change each xi to a smaller number
so that our calculations become easy. How do we do this? What about subtracting a
fixed number from each of these xi’s? Let us try this method.
The first step is to choose one among the xi’ s as the assumed mean, and denote
it by ‘a’. Also, to further reduce our calculation work, we may take ‘a’ to be that xi
which lies in the centre of x1, x2 , . . ., xn. So, we can choose a = 47.5 or a = 62.5. Let
us choose a = 47.5.
The next step is to find the difference d i between a and each of the xi’s, that is,
the deviation of ‘a’ from each of the xi’s.
i.e., di = xi – a = xi – 47.5
264 MATHEMATICS
The third step is to find the product of d i with the corresponding fi, and take the sum
of all the f i d i’s. The calculations are shown in Table 14.4.
Table 14.4
fi d i
So, from Table 14.4, the mean of the deviations, d = .
f i
fi d i
Mean of deviations, d =
f i
fi (xi a)
So, d =
fi
fi xi f i a
=
fi fi
fi
= xa
fi
= xa
So, x =a+ d
f i di
i.e., x = a
fi
STATISTICS 265
Substituting the values of a, Σfidi and Σfi from Table 14.4, we get
435
x = 47.5 47.5 14.5 62 .
30
Therefore, the mean of the marks obtained by the students is 62.
The method discussed above is called the Assumed Mean Method.
Activity 1 : From the Table 14.3 find the mean by taking each of xi (i.e., 17.5, 32.5,
and so on) as ‘a’. What do you observe? You will find that the mean determined in
each case is the same, i.e., 62. (Why ?)
So, we can say that the value of the mean obtained does not depend on the
choice of ‘a’.
Observe that in Table 14.4, the values in Column 4 are all multiples of 15. So, if
we divide the values in the entire Column 4 by 15, we would get smaller numbers to
multiply with fi. (Here, 15 is the class size of each class interval.)
xi a
So, let u i = , where a is the assumed mean and h is the class size.
h
Now, we calculate u i in this way and continue as before (i.e., find f i u i and
then Σ fi u i). Taking h = 15, let us form Table 14.5.
Table 14.5
xi – a
Class interval fi xi di = x i – a ui = f iu i
h
10 - 25 2 17.5 –30 –2 –4
25 - 40 3 32.5 –15 –1 –3
40 - 55 7 47.5 0 0 0
55 - 70 6 62.5 15 1 6
70 - 85 6 77.5 30 2 12
85 - 100 6 92.5 45 3 18
fi ui
Let u =
fi
Here, again let us find the relation between u and x .
266 MATHEMATICS
xi a
We have, ui =
h
( xi a )
fi
h 1 f x a f i
Therefore, u = i i
fi h f i
1 fi xi f
= a i
h fi fi
1
= x a
h
So, hu = x a
i.e., x = a + hu
f u
So, x = a h i i
fi
Now, substituting the values of a, h, Σfiui and Σfi from Table 14.5, we get
29
x = 47.5 15
30
= 47.5 + 14.5 = 62
So, the mean marks obtained by a student is 62.
The method discussed above is called the Step -deviation method.
We note that :
the step-deviation method will be convenient to apply if all the d i’s have a
common factor.
The mean obtained by all the three methods is the same.
The assumed mean method and step-deviation method are just simplified
forms of the direct method.
The formula x = a + hu still holds if a and h are not as given above, but are
xi a
any non-zero numbers such that ui = .
h
Let us apply these methods in another example.
STATISTICS 267
Example 2 : The table below gives the percentage distribution of female teachers in
the primary schools of rural areas of various states and union territories (U.T.) of
India. Find the mean percentage of female teachers by all the three methods discussed
in this section.
Percentage of 15 - 25 25 - 35 35 - 45 45 - 55 55 - 65 65 - 75 75 - 85
female teachers
Number of 6 11 7 4 4 2 1
States/U.T.
Solution : Let us find the class marks, xi, of each class, and put them in a column
(see Table 14.6):
Table 14.6
15 - 25 6 20
25 - 35 11 30
35 - 45 7 40
45 - 55 4 50
55 - 65 4 60
65 - 75 2 70
75 - 85 1 80
x i 50
Here we take a = 50, h = 10, then di = xi – 50 and ui .
10
Table 14.7
fi xi 1390
Using the direct method, x 39.71
fi 35
Using the assumed mean method,
fi d i ( 360)
x = a = 50 39.71
fi 35
Using the step-deviation method,
f u – 36
x = a i i h 50 10 39.71
fi 35
Therefore, the mean percentage of female teachers in the primary schools of
rural areas is 39.71.
Remark : The result obtained by all the three methods is the same. So the choice of
method to be used depends on the numerical values of xi and f i. If xi and fi are
sufficiently small, then the direct method is an appropriate choice. If xi and fi are
numerically large numbers, then we can go for the assumed mean method or
step-deviation method. If the class sizes are unequal, and xi are large numerically, we
can still apply the step-deviation method by taking h to be a suitable divisor of all the di’s.
STATISTICS 269
Example 3 : The distribution below shows the number of wickets taken by bowlers in
one-day cricket matches. Find the mean number of wickets by choosing a suitable
method. What does the mean signify?
Number of 20 - 60 60 - 100 100 - 150 150 - 250 250 - 350 350 - 450
wickets
Number of 7 5 16 12 2 3
bowlers
Solution : Here, the class size varies, and the xi, s are large. Let us still apply the step-
deviation method with a = 200 and h = 20. Then, we obtain the data as in Table 14.8.
Table 14.8
di
Number of Number of xi di = xi – 200 ui = ui fi
20
wickets bowlers
taken ( fi )
20 - 60 7 40 –160 –8 –56
60 - 100 5 80 –120 –6 –30
100 - 150 16 125 –75 –3.75 –60
150 - 250 12 200 0 0 0
250 - 350 2 300 100 5 10
350 - 450 3 400 200 10 30
Total 45 –106
106 106
So, u Therefore, x = 200 + 20 = 200 – 47.11 = 152.89.
45 45
This tells us that, on an average, the number of wickets taken by these 45 bowlers
in one-day cricket is 152.89.
Now, let us see how well you can apply the concepts discussed in this section!
270 MATHEMATICS
Activity 2 :
Divide the students of your class into three groups and ask each group to do one of the
following activities.
1. Collect the marks obtained by all the students of your class in Mathematics in the
latest examination conducted by your school. Form a grouped frequency distribution
of the data obtained.
2. Collect the daily maximum temperatures recorded for a period of 30 days in your
city. Present this data as a grouped frequency table.
3. Measure the heights of all the students of your class (in cm) and form a grouped
frequency distribution table of this data.
After all the groups have collected the data and formed grouped frequency
distribution tables, the groups should find the mean in each case by the method which
they find appropriate.
EXERCISE 14.1
1. A survey was conducted by a group of students as a part of their environment awareness
programme, in which they collected the following data regarding the number of plants in
20 houses in a locality. Find the mean number of plants per house.
Number of houses 1 2 1 5 6 2 3
Which method did you use for finding the mean, and why?
2. Consider the following distribution of daily wages of 50 workers of a factory.
Daily wages (in `) 100 - 120 120 - 140 140 - 160 160 - 180 180 - 200
Number of workers 12 14 8 6 10
Find the mean daily wages of the workers of the factory by using an appropriate method.
3. The following distribution shows the daily pocket allowance of children of a locality.
The mean pocket allowance is Rs 18. Find the missing frequency f.
Daily pocket 11 - 13 13 - 15 15 - 17 17 - 19 19 - 21 21 - 23 23 - 25
allowance (in `)
Number of children 7 6 9 13 f 5 4
STATISTICS 271
4. Thirty women were examined in a hospital by a doctor and the number of heart beats per
minute were recorded and summarised as follows. Find the mean heart beats per minute
for these women, choosing a suitable method.
Number of women 2 4 3 8 7 4 2
5. In a retail market, fruit vendors were selling mangoes kept in packing boxes. These
boxes contained varying number of mangoes. The following was the distribution of
mangoes according to the number of boxes.
Number of mangoes 50 - 52 53 - 55 56 - 58 59 - 61 62 - 64
Find the mean number of mangoes kept in a packing box. Which method of finding
the mean did you choose?
6. The table below shows the daily expenditure on food of 25 households in a locality.
Daily expenditure 100 - 150 150 - 200 200 - 250 250 - 300 300 - 350
(in `)
Number of 4 5 12 2 2
households
0.00 - 0.04 4
0.04 - 0.08 9
0.08 - 0.12 9
0.12 - 0.16 2
0.16 - 0.20 4
0.20 - 0.24 2
8. A class teacher has the following absentee record of 40 students of a class for the whole
term. Find the mean number of days a student was absent.
Number of 0-6 6 - 10 10 - 14 14 - 20 20 - 28 28 - 38 38 - 40
days
Number of 11 10 7 4 4 3 1
students
9. The following table gives the literacy rate (in percentage) of 35 cities. Find the mean
literacy rate.
Number of cities 3 10 11 8 3
Number of 0 1 2 3 4 5 6
wickets
Number of 1 1 3 2 1 1 1
matches
STATISTICS 273
Clearly, 2 is the number of wickets taken by the bowler in the maximum number
(i.e., 3) of matches. So, the mode of this data is 2.
In a grouped frequency distribution, it is not possible to determine the mode by
looking at the frequencies. Here, we can only locate a class with the maximum
frequency, called the modal class. The mode is a value inside the modal class, and is
given by the formula:
f1 f0
Mode = l h
2 f1 f 0 f 2
where l = lower limit of the modal class,
h = size of the class interval (assuming all class sizes to be equal),
f1 = frequency of the modal class,
f0 = frequency of the class preceding the modal class,
f2 = frequency of the class succeeding the modal class.
Let us consider the following examples to illustrate the use of this formula.
Number of 7 8 2 2 1
families
f1 f0
Mode = l h
2 f1 f 0 f 2
87 2
= 3 2 3 3.286
2 8 7 2 7
of the students. In the first situation, the mean is required and in the second situation,
the mode is required.
Activity 3 : Continuing with the same groups as formed in Activity 2 and the situations
assigned to the groups. Ask each group to find the mode of the data. They should also
compare this with the mean, and interpret the meaning of both.
Remark : The mode can also be calculated for grouped data with unequal class sizes.
However, we shall not be discussing it.
EXERCISE 14.2
1. The following table shows the ages of the patients admitted in a hospital during a year:
Number of patients 6 11 21 23 14 5
Find the mode and the mean of the data given above. Compare and interpret the two
measures of central tendency.
2. The following data gives the information on the observed lifetimes (in hours) of 225
electrical components :
Frequency 10 35 52 61 38 29
1000 - 1500 24
1500 - 2000 40
2000 - 2500 33
2500 - 3000 28
3000 - 3500 30
3500 - 4000 22
4000 - 4500 16
4500 - 5000 7
276 MATHEMATICS
15 - 20 3
20 - 25 8
25 - 30 9
30 - 35 10
35 - 40 3
40 - 45 0
45 - 50 0
50 - 55 2
5. The given distribution shows the number of runs scored by some top batsmen of the
world in one-day international cricket matches.
3000 - 4000 4
4000 - 5000 18
5000 - 6000 9
6000 - 7000 7
7000 - 8000 6
8000 - 9000 3
9000 - 10000 1
10000 - 11000 1
Find the mode of the data.
6. A student noted the number of cars passing through a spot on a road for 100
periods each of 3 minutes and summarised it in the table given below. Find the mode
of the data :
Number of cars 0 - 10 10 - 20 20 - 30 30 - 40 40 - 50 50 - 60 60 - 70 70 - 80
Frequency 7 14 13 12 20 11 15 8
STATISTICS 277
Suppose, we have to find the median of the following data, which gives the
marks, out of 50, obtained by 100 students in a test :
Marks obtained 20 29 28 33 42 38 43 25
Number of students 6 28 24 15 2 4 1 20
First, we arrange the marks in ascending order and prepare a frequency table as
follows :
Table 14.9
20 6
25 20
28 24
29 28
33 15
38 4
42 2
43 1
Total 100
278 MATHEMATICS
n
Here n = 100, which is even. The median will be the average of the th and the
2
n
1 th observations, i.e., the 50th and 51st observations. To find these
2
observations, we proceed as follows:
Table 14.10
20 6
upto 25 6 + 20 = 26
upto 28 26 + 24 = 50
upto 29 50 + 28 = 78
upto 33 78 + 15 = 93
upto 38 93 + 4 = 97
upto 42 97 + 2 = 99
upto 43 99 + 1 = 100
Now we add another column depicting this information to the frequency table
above and name it as cumulative frequency column.
Table 14.11
20 6 6
25 20 26
28 24 50
29 28 78
33 15 93
38 4 97
42 2 99
43 1 100
STATISTICS 279
28 29
So, Median = 28.5
2
Remark : The part of Table 14.11 consisting Column 1 and Column 3 is known as
Cumulative Frequency Table. The median marks 28.5 conveys the information that
about 50% students obtained marks less than 28.5 and another 50% students obtained
marks more than 28.5.
Now, let us see how to obtain the median of grouped data, through the following
situation.
Consider a grouped frequency distribution of marks obtained, out of 100, by 53
students, in a certain examination, as follows:
Table 14.12
0 - 10 5
10 - 20 3
20 - 30 4
30 - 40 3
40 - 50 3
50 - 60 4
60 - 70 7
70 - 80 9
80 - 90 7
90 - 100 8
How many students have scored less than 20 marks? Observe that the number
of students who have scored less than 20 include the number of students who have
scored marks from 0 - 10 as well as the number of students who have scored marks
from 10 - 20. So, the total number of students with marks less than 20 is 5 + 3, i.e., 8.
We say that the cumulative frequency of the class 10 -20 is 8.
Similarly, we can compute the cumulative frequencies of the other classes, i.e.,
the number of students with marks less than 30, less than 40, . . ., less than 100. We
give them in Table 14.13 given below:
Table 14.13
Less than 10 5
Less than 20 5+3=8
Less than 30 8 + 4 = 12
Less than 40 12 + 3 = 15
Less than 50 15 + 3 = 18
Less than 60 18 + 4 = 22
Less than 70 22 + 7 = 29
Less than 80 29 + 9 = 38
Less than 90 38 + 7 = 45
Less than 100 45 + 8 = 53
Table 14.14
Table 14.15
0 - 10 5 5
10 - 20 3 8
20 - 30 4 12
30 - 40 3 15
40 - 50 3 18
50 - 60 4 22
60 - 70 7 29
70 - 80 9 38
80 - 90 7 45
90 - 100 8 53
Now in a grouped data, we may not be able to find the middle observation by
looking at the cumulative frequencies as the middle observation will be some value in
282 MATHEMATICS
a class interval. It is, therefore, necessary to find the value inside a class that divides
the whole distribution into two halves. But which class should this be?
n
To find this class, we find the cumulative frequencies of all the classes and .
2
We now locate the class whose cumulative frequency is greater than (and nearest to)
n n
This is called the median class. In the distribution above, n = 53. So, = 26.5.
2 2
Now 60 – 70 is the class whose cumulative frequency 29 is greater than (and nearest
n
to) , i.e., 26.5.
2
Therefore, 60 – 70 is the median class.
After finding the median class, we use the following formula for calculating the
median.
n
2 cf
Median = l + h,
f
where l = lower limit of median class,
n = number of observations,
cf = cumulative frequency of class preceding the median class,
f = frequency of median class,
h = class size (assuming class size to be equal).
n
Substituting the values 26.5, l = 60, cf = 22, f = 7, h = 10
2
in the formula above, we get
26.5 22
Median = 60 10
7
45
= 60 +
7
= 66.4
So, about half the students have scored marks less than 66.4, and the other half have
scored marks more than 66.4.
STATISTICS 283
Example 7 : A survey regarding the heights (in cm) of 51 girls of Class X of a school
was conducted and the following data was obtained:
Table 14.16
Below 140 4 4
140 - 145 7 11
145 - 150 18 29
150 - 155 11 40
155 - 160 6 46
160 - 165 5 51
284 MATHEMATICS
n 51
Now n = 51. So, 25.5 . This observation lies in the class 145 - 150. Then,
2 2
l (the lower limit) = 145,
cf (the cumulative frequency of the class preceding 145 - 150) = 11,
f (the frequency of the median class 145 - 150) = 18,
h (the class size) = 5.
n
2 cf
Using the formula, Median = l + h , we have
f
25.5 11
Median = 145 5
18
72.5
= 145 + = 149.03.
18
So, the median height of the girls is 149.03 cm.
This means that the height of about 50% of the girls is less than this height, and
50% are taller than this height.
Example 8 : The median of the following data is 525. Find the values of x and y, if the
total frequency is 100.
0 - 100 2
100 - 200 5
200 - 300 x
300 - 400 12
400 - 500 17
500 - 600 20
600 - 700 y
700 - 800 9
800 - 900 7
900 - 1000 4
STATISTICS 285
Solution :
0 - 100 2 2
100 - 200 5 7
200 - 300 x 7 +x
300 - 400 12 19 + x
400 - 500 17 36 + x
500 - 600 20 56 + x
600 - 700 y 56 + x + y
700 - 800 9 65 + x + y
800 - 900 7 72 + x + y
900 - 1000 4 76 + x + y
n
cf
Using the formula : Median = l 2 h , we get
f
50 36 x
525 = 500 100
20
i.e., 525 – 500 = (14 – x) × 5
i.e., 25 = 70 – 5x
i.e., 5x = 70 – 25 = 45
So, x= 9
Therefore, from (1), we get 9 + y = 24
i.e., y = 15
286 MATHEMATICS
Now, that you have studied about all the three measures of central tendency, let
us discuss which measure would be best suited for a particular requirement.
The mean is the most frequently used measure of central tendency because it
takes into account all the observations, and lies between the extremes, i.e., the largest
and the smallest observations of the entire data. It also enables us to compare two or
more distributions. For example, by comparing the average (mean) results of students
of different schools of a particular examination, we can conclude which school has a
better performance.
However, extreme values in the data affect the mean. For example, the mean of
classes having frequencies more or less the same is a good representative of the data.
But, if one class has frequency, say 2, and the five others have frequency 20, 25, 20,
21, 18, then the mean will certainly not reflect the way the data behaves. So, in such
cases, the mean is not a good representative of the data.
In problems where individual observations are not important, and we wish to find
out a ‘typical’ observation, the median is more appropriate, e.g., finding the typical
productivity rate of workers, average wage in a country, etc. These are situations
where extreme values may be there. So, rather than the mean, we take the median as
a better measure of central tendency.
In situations which require establishing the most frequent value or most popular
item, the mode is the best choice, e.g., to find the most popular T.V. programme being
watched, the consumer item in greatest demand, the colour of the vehicle used by
most of the people, etc.
Remarks :
1. There is a empirical relationship between the three measures of central tendency :
3 Median = Mode + 2 Mean
2. The median of grouped data with unequal class sizes can also be calculated. However,
we shall not discuss it here.
STATISTICS 287
EXERCISE 14.3
1. The following frequency distribution gives the monthly consumption of electricity of
68 consumers of a locality. Find the median, mean and mode of the data and compare
them.
65 - 85 4
85 - 105 5
105 - 125 13
125 - 145 20
145 - 165 14
165 - 185 8
185 - 205 4
2. If the median of the distribution given below is 28.5, find the values of x and y.
0 - 10 5
10 - 20 x
20 - 30 20
30 - 40 15
40 - 50 y
50 - 60 5
Total 60
3. A life insurance agent found the following data for distribution of ages of 100 policy
holders. Calculate the median age, if policies are given only to persons having age 18
years onwards but less than 60 year.
288 MATHEMATICS
Below 20 2
Below 25 6
Below 30 24
Below 35 45
Below 40 78
Below 45 89
Below 50 92
Below 55 98
Below 60 100
4. The lengths of 40 leaves of a plant are measured correct to the nearest millimetre, and
the data obtained is represented in the following table :
118 - 126 3
127 - 135 5
136 - 144 9
145 - 153 12
154 - 162 5
163 - 171 4
172 - 180 2
5. The following table gives the distribution of the life time of 400 neon lamps :
1500 - 2000 14
2000 - 2500 56
2500 - 3000 60
3000 - 3500 86
3500 - 4000 74
4000 - 4500 62
4500 - 5000 48
Number of surnames 6 30 40 16 4 4
Determine the median number of letters in the surnames. Find the mean number of
letters in the surnames? Also, find the modal size of the surnames.
7. The distribution below gives the weights of 30 students of a class. Find the median
weight of the students.
Number of students 2 3 8 6 6 3 2
The term ‘ogive’ is pronounced as ‘ojeev’ and is derived from the word ogee.
An ogee is a shape consisting of a concave arc flowing into a convex arc, so
forming an S-shaped curve with vertical ends. In architecture, the ogee shape
is one of the characteristics of the 14th and 15th century Gothic styles.
Table 14.17
Classes 5 - 10 10 - 15 15 - 20 20 - 25 25 - 30 30 - 35 35 - 40
No. of shops 2 12 2 4 3 4 3
Cumulative 2 14 16 20 23 27 30
frequency
EXERCISE 14.4
1. The following distribution gives the daily income of 50 workers of a factory.
Daily income (in `) 100 - 120 120 - 140 140 - 160 160 - 180 180 - 200
Number of workers 12 14 8 6 10
Convert the distribution above to a less than type cumulative frequency distribution,
and draw its ogive.
2. During the medical check-up of 35 students of a class, their weights were recorded as
follows:
Less than 38 0
Less than 40 3
Less than 42 5
Less than 44 9
Less than 46 14
Less than 48 28
Less than 50 32
Less than 52 35
Draw a less than type ogive for the given data. Hence obtain the median weight from
the graph and verify the result by using the formula.
3. The following table gives production yield per hectare of wheat of 100 farms of a village.
Production yield 50 - 55 55 - 60 60 - 65 65 - 70 70 - 75 75 - 80
(in kg/ha)
Number of farms 2 8 12 24 38 16
Change the distribution to a more than type distribution, and draw its ogive.
14.6 Summary
In this chapter, you have studied the following points:
1. The mean for grouped data can be found by :
fi xi
(i) the direct method : x
f i
294 MATHEMATICS
f i d i
(ii) the assumed mean method : x a
f i
f u
(iii) the step deviation method : x a i i h ,
f i
with the assumption that the frequency of a class is centred at its mid-point, called its
class mark.
2. The mode for grouped data can be found by using the formula:
f1 f0
Mode = l h
2 f1 f0 f2
where symbols have their usual meanings.
3. The cumulative frequency of a class is the frequency obtained by adding the frequencies
of all the classes preceding the given class.
4. The median for grouped data is formed by using the formula:
n cf
Median = l 2 h,
f
PROBABILITY 15
The theory of probabilities and the theory of errors now constitute
a formidable body of great mathematical interest and of great
practical importance.
– R.S. Woodward
15.1 Introduction
In Class IX, you have studied about experimental (or empirical) probabilities of events
which were based on the results of actual experiments. We discussed an experiment
of tossing a coin 1000 times in which the frequencies of the outcomes were as follows:
Head : 455 Tail : 545
455
Based on this experiment, the empirical probability of a head is , i.e., 0.455 and
1000
that of getting a tail is 0.545. (Also see Example 1, Chapter 15 of Class IX Mathematics
Textbook.) Note that these probabilities are based on the results of an actual experiment
of tossing a coin 1000 times. For this reason, they are called experimental or empirical
probabilities. In fact, experimental probabilities are based on the results of actual
experiments and adequate recordings of the happening of the events. Moreover,
these probabilities are only ‘estimates’. If we perform the same experiment for another
1000 times, we may get different data giving different probability estimates.
In Class IX, you tossed a coin many times and noted the number of times it turned up
heads (or tails) (refer to Activities 1 and 2 of Chapter 15). You also noted that as the
number of tosses of the coin increased, the experimental probability of getting a head
1
(or tail) came closer and closer to the number Not only you, but many other
2
296 MATHEMATICS
persons from different parts of the world have done this kind of experiment and recorded
the number of heads that turned up.
For example, the eighteenth century French naturalist Comte de Buffon tossed a
coin 4040 times and got 2048 heads. The experimental probabilility of getting a head,
in this case, was 2048 , i.e., 0.507. J.E. Kerrich, from Britain, recorded 5067 heads in
4040
10000 tosses of a coin. The experimental probability of getting a head, in this case,
5067
was 0.5067 . Statistician Karl Pearson spent some more time, making 24000
10000
tosses of a coin. He got 12012 heads, and thus, the experimental probability of a head
obtained by him was 0.5005.
Now, suppose we ask, ‘What will the experimental probability of a head be if the
experiment is carried on upto, say, one million times? Or 10 million times? And so on?’
You would intuitively feel that as the number of tosses increases, the experimental
probability of a head (or a tail) seems to be settling down around the number 0.5 , i.e.,
1
, which is what we call the theoretical probability of getting a head (or getting a
2
tail), as you will see in the next section. In this chapter, we provide an introduction to
the theoretical (also called classical) probability of an event, and discuss simple problems
based on this concept.
We know, in advance, that the coin can only land in one of two possible ways —
either head up or tail up (we dismiss the possibility of its ‘landing’ on its edge, which
may be possible, for example, if it falls on sand). We can reasonably assume that each
outcome, head or tail, is as likely to occur as the other. We refer to this by saying that
the outcomes head and tail, are equally likely.
PROBABILITY 297
where we assume that the outcomes of the experiment are equally likely.
We will briefly refer to theoretical probability as probability.
This definition of probability was given by Pierre Simon Laplace in 1795.
Let us find the probability for some of the events associated with experiments
where the equally likely assumption holds.
Example 1 : Find the probability of getting a head when a coin is tossed once. Also
find the probability of getting a tail.
Solution : In the experiment of tossing a coin once, the number of possible outcomes
is two — Head (H) and Tail (T). Let E be the event ‘getting a head’. The number of
outcomes favourable to E, (i.e., of getting a head) is 1. Therefore,
Example 2 : A bag contains a red ball, a blue ball and a yellow ball, all the balls being
of the same size. Kritika takes out a ball from the bag without looking into it. What is
the probability that she takes out the
(i) yellow ball? (ii) red ball? (iii) blue ball?
PROBABILITY 299
Solution : Kritika takes out a ball from the bag without looking into it. So, it is equally
likely that she takes out any one of them.
Let Y be the event ‘the ball taken out is yellow’, B be the event ‘the ball taken
out is blue’, and R be the event ‘the ball taken out is red’.
Now, the number of possible outcomes = 3.
(i) The number of outcomes favourable to the event Y = 1.
1
So, P(Y) =
3
1 1
Similarly, (ii) P(R) = and (iii) P(B) =
3 3
Remarks :
1. An event having only one outcome of the experiment is called an elementary
event. In Example 1, both the events E and F are elementary events. Similarly, in
Example 2, all the three events, Y, B and R are elementary events.
2. In Example 1, we note that : P(E) + P(F) = 1
In Example 2, we note that : P(Y) + P(R) + P(B) = 1
Observe that the sum of the probabilities of all the elementary events of
an experiment is 1. This is true in general also.
Example 3 : Suppose we throw a die once. (i) What is the probability of getting a
number greater than 4 ? (ii) What is the probability of getting a number less than or
equal to 4 ?
Solution : (i) Here, let E be the event ‘getting a number greater than 4’. The number
of possible outcomes is six : 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6, and the outcomes favourable to E are 5
and 6. Therefore, the number of outcomes favourable to E is 2. So,
2 1
P(E) = P(number greater than 4) = =
6 3
(ii) Let F be the event ‘getting a number less than or equal to 4’.
Number of possible outcomes = 6
Outcomes favourable to the event F are 1, 2, 3, 4.
So, the number of outcomes favourable to F is 4.
4 2
Therefore, P(F) = =
6 3
300 MATHEMATICS
Are the events E and F in the example above elementary events? No, they are
not because the event E has 2 outcomes and the event F has 4 outcomes.
Remarks : From Example 1, we note that
1 1
P(E) + P(F) = 1 (1)
2 2
where E is the event ‘getting a head’ and F is the event ‘getting a tail’.
From (i) and (ii) of Example 3, we also get
1 2
P(E) + P(F) = 1 (2)
3 3
where E is the event ‘getting a number >4’ and F is the event ‘getting a number ≤ 4’.
Note that getting a number not greater than 4 is same as getting a number less
than or equal to 4, and vice versa.
In (1) and (2) above, is F not the same as ‘not E’? Yes, it is. We denote the event
‘not E’ by E .
So, P(E) + P(not E) = 1
i.e., P(E) + P( E ) = 1, which gives us P( E ) = 1 – P(E).
In general, it is true that for an event E,
P( E ) = 1 – P(E)
The event E , representing ‘not E’, is called the complement of the event E.
We also say that E and E are complementary events.
Before proceeding further, let us try to find the answers to the following questions:
(i) What is the probability of getting a number 8 in a single throw of a die?
(ii) What is the probability of getting a number less than 7 in a single throw of a die?
Let us answer (i) :
We know that there are only six possible outcomes in a single throw of a die. These
outcomes are 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6. Since no face of the die is marked 8, so there is no
outcome favourable to 8, i.e., the number of such outcomes is zero. In other words,
getting 8 in a single throw of a die, is impossible.
0
So, P(getting 8) = =0
6
PROBABILITY 301
Example 5 : Two players, Sangeeta and Reshma, play a tennis match. It is known
that the probability of Sangeeta winning the match is 0.62. What is the probability of
Reshma winning the match?
Solution : Let S and R denote the events that Sangeeta wins the match and Reshma
wins the match, respectively.
The probability of Sangeeta’s winning = P(S) = 0.62 (given)
The probability of Reshma’s winning = P(R) = 1 – P(S)
[As the events R and S are complementary]
= 1 – 0.62 = 0.38
Example 6 : Savita and Hamida are friends. What is the probability that both will
have (i) different birthdays? (ii) the same birthday? (ignoring a leap year).
Solution : Out of the two friends, one girl, say, Savita’s birthday can be any day of the
year. Now, Hamida’s birthday can also be any day of 365 days in the year.
We assume that these 365 outcomes are equally likely.
(i) If Hamida’s birthday is different from Savita’s, the number of favourable outcomes
for her birthday is 365 – 1 = 364
364
So, P (Hamida’s birthday is different from Savita’s birthday) =
365
(ii) P(Savita and Hamida have the same birthday)
= 1 – P (both have different birthdays)
364
= 1 [Using P( E ) = 1 – P(E)]
365
1
=
365
PROBABILITY 303
Example 7 : There are 40 students in Class X of a school of whom 25 are girls and 15
are boys. The class teacher has to select one student as a class representative. She
writes the name of each student on a separate card, the cards being identical. Then
she puts cards in a bag and stirs them thoroughly. She then draws one card from the
bag. What is the probability that the name written on the card is the name of (i) a girl?
(ii) a boy?
Solution : There are 40 students, and only one name card has to be chosen.
(i) The number of all possible outcomes is 40
The number of outcomes favourable for a card with the name of a girl = 25 (Why?)
25 5
Therefore, P (card with name of a girl) = P(Girl) =
40 8
(ii) The number of outcomes favourable for a card with the name of a boy = 15 (Why?)
15 3
Therefore, P(card with name of a boy) = P(Boy) =
40 8
Note : We can also determine P(Boy), by taking
5 3
P(Boy) = 1 – P(not Boy) = 1 – P(Girl) = 1
8 8
Example 8 : A box contains 3 blue, 2 white, and 4 red marbles. If a marble is drawn
at random from the box, what is the probability that it will be
(i) white? (ii) blue? (iii) red?
Solution : Saying that a marble is drawn at random is a short way of saying that all the
marbles are equally likely to be drawn. Therefore, the
number of possible outcomes = 3 +2 + 4 = 9 (Why?)
Let W denote the event ‘the marble is white’, B denote the event ‘the marble is blue’
and R denote the event ‘marble is red’.
(i) The number of outcomes favourable to the event W = 2
2
So, P(W) =
9
3 1 4
Similarly, (ii) P(B) = = and (iii) P(R) =
9 3 9
1 3 1
P (E) = 1 – P (E) = 1 – Since P(E) = P(no head) =
4 4 4
Did you observe that in all the examples discussed so far, the number of possible
outcomes in each experiment was finite? If not, check it now.
There are many experiments in which the outcome is any number between two
given numbers, or in which the outcome is every point within a circle or rectangle, etc.
Can you now count the number of all possible outcomes? As you know, this is not
possible since there are infinitely many numbers between two given numbers, or there
are infinitely many points within a circle. So, the definition of (theoretical) probability
which you have learnt so far cannot be applied in the present form. What is the way
out? To answer this, let us consider the following example :
Example 10* : In a musical chair game, the person playing the music has been
advised to stop playing the music at any time within 2 minutes after she starts playing.
What is the probability that the music will stop within the first half-minute after starting?
Solution : Here the possible outcomes are all the numbers between 0 and 2. This is
the portion of the number line from 0 to 2 (see Fig. 15.1).
Fig. 15.1
Let E be the event that ‘the music is stopped within the first half-minute’.
1
The outcomes favourable to E are points on the number line from 0 to .
2
1 1
The distance from 0 to 2 is 2, while the distance from 0 to is .
2 2
Since all the outcomes are equally likely, we can argue that, of the total distance
1
of 2, the distance favourable to the event E is .
2
1
Distance favourable to the event E 2 1
So, P(E) = =
Total distance in which outcomes can lie 2 4
Can we now extend the idea of Example 10 for finding the probability as the ratio of
the favourable area to the total area?
Fig. 15.2
Solution : The helicopter is equally likely to crash anywhere in the region.
Area of the entire region where the helicopter can crash
= (4.5 × 9) km2 = 40.5 km2
Example 12 : A carton consists of 100 shirts of which 88 are good, 8 have minor
defects and 4 have major defects. Jimmy, a trader, will only accept the shirts which
are good, but Sujatha, another trader, will only reject the shirts which have major
defects. One shirt is drawn at random from the carton. What is the probability that
Solution : One shirt is drawn at random from the carton of 100 shirts. Therefore,
there are 100 equally likely outcomes.
Solution : When the blue die shows ‘1’, the grey die could show any one of the
numbers 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6. The same is true when the blue die shows ‘2’, ‘3’, ‘4’, ‘5’ or
‘6’. The possible outcomes of the experiment are listed in the table below; the first
number in each ordered pair is the number appearing on the blue die and the second
number is that on the grey die.
PROBABILITY 307
4
6 5
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 (1, 1) (1, 2) (1, 3) (1, 4) (1, 5) (1, 6)
2 (2, 1) (2, 2) (2, 3) (2, 4) (2, 5) (2, 6)
4
3 (3, 1) (3, 2) (3, 3) (3, 4) (3, 5) (3, 6)
6 5
4 (4, 1) (4, 2) (4, 3) (4, 4) (4, 5) (4, 6)
5 (5, 1) (5, 2) (5, 3) (5, 4) (5, 5) (5, 6)
6 (6, 1) (6, 2) (6, 3) (6, 4) (6, 5) (6, 6)
Fig. 15.3
Note that the pair (1, 4) is different from (4, 1). (Why?)
So, the number of possible outcomes = 6 × 6 = 36.
(i) The outcomes favourable to the event ‘the sum of the two numbers is 8’ denoted
by E, are: (2, 6), (3, 5), (4, 4), (5, 3), (6, 2) (see Fig. 15.3)
i.e., the number of outcomes favourable to E = 5.
5
Hence, P(E) =
36
(ii) As you can see from Fig. 15.3, there is no outcome favourable to the event F,
‘the sum of two numbers is 13’.
0
So, P(F) = 0
36
(iii) As you can see from Fig. 15.3, all the outcomes are favourable to the event G,
‘sum of two numbers ≤ 12’.
36
So, P(G) = 1
36
308 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 15.1
1. Complete the following statements:
(i) Probability of an event E + Probability of the event ‘not E’ = .
(ii) The probability of an event that cannot happen is . Such an event is
called .
(iii) The probability of an event that is certain to happen is . Such an event
is called .
(iv) The sum of the probabilities of all the elementary events of an experiment is
.
(v) The probability of an event is greater than or equal to and less than or
equal to .
2. Which of the following experiments have equally likely outcomes? Explain.
(i) A driver attempts to start a car. The car starts or does not start.
(ii) A player attempts to shoot a basketball. She/he shoots or misses the shot.
(iii) A trial is made to answer a true-false question. The answer is right or wrong.
(iv) A baby is born. It is a boy or a girl.
3. Why is tossing a coin considered to be a fair way of deciding which team should get the
ball at the beginning of a football game?
4. Which of the following cannot be the probability of an event?
2
(A) (B) –1.5 (C) 15% (D) 0.7
3
5. If P(E) = 0.05, what is the probability of ‘not E’?
6. A bag contains lemon flavoured candies only. Malini takes out one candy without
looking into the bag. What is the probability that she takes out
(i) an orange flavoured candy?
(ii) a lemon flavoured candy?
7. It is given that in a group of 3 students, the probability of 2 students not having the
same birthday is 0.992. What is the probability that the 2 students have the same
birthday?
8. A bag contains 3 red balls and 5 black balls. A ball is drawn at random from the bag.
What is the probability that the ball drawn is (i) red ? (ii) not red?
9. A box contains 5 red marbles, 8 white marbles and 4 green marbles. One marble is taken
out of the box at random. What is the probability that the marble taken out will be
(i) red ? (ii) white ? (iii) not green?
PROBABILITY 309
10. A piggy bank contains hundred 50p coins, fifty ` 1 coins, twenty ` 2 coins and ten ` 5
coins. If it is equally likely that one of the coins will fall out when the bank is turned
upside down, what is the probability that the coin (i) will be a 50 p coin ? (ii) will not be
a ` 5 coin?
11. Gopi buys a fish from a shop for his aquarium. The
shopkeeper takes out one fish at random from a
tank containing 5 male fish and 8 female fish (see
Fig. 15.4). What is the probability that the fish taken
out is a male fish?
19. A child has a die whose six faces show the letters as given below:
A B C D E A
The die is thrown once. What is the probability of getting (i) A? (ii) D?
20*. Suppose you drop a die at random on the rectangular region shown in Fig. 15.6. What is
the probability that it will land inside the circle with diameter 1m?
3m
2m
Fig. 15.6
21. A lot consists of 144 ball pens of which 20 are defective and the others are good. Nuri
will buy a pen if it is good, but will not buy if it is defective. The shopkeeper draws one
pen at random and gives it to her. What is the probability that
(i) She will buy it ?
(ii) She will not buy it ?
22. Refer to Example 13. (i) Complete the following table:
Event :
‘Sum on 2 dice’ 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 5 1
Probability
36 36 36
(ii) A student argues that ‘there are 11 possible outcomes 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11 and
1
12. Therefore, each of them has a probability . Do you agree with this argument?
11
Justify your answer.
23. A game consists of tossing a one rupee coin 3 times and noting its outcome each time.
Hanif wins if all the tosses give the same result i.e., three heads or three tails, and loses
otherwise. Calculate the probability that Hanif will lose the game.
24. A die is thrown twice. What is the probability that
(i) 5 will not come up either time? (ii) 5 will come up at least once?
[Hint : Throwing a die twice and throwing two dice simultaneously are treated as the
same experiment]
25. Which of the following arguments are correct and which are not correct? Give reasons
for your answer.
(i) If two coins are tossed simultaneously there are three possible outcomes — two
heads, two tails or one of each. Therefore, for each of these outcomes, the
1
probability is
3
(ii) If a die is thrown, there are two possible outcomes —an odd number or an even
1
number. Therefore, the probability of getting an odd number is .
2
1 2 3 3 4 4 7
2 3 4 4 5 5 8
2 5
3
3 5 9
6 7 8 8 9 9 12
5. A jar contains 24 marbles, some are green and others are blue. If a marble is drawn at
2
random from the jar, the probability that it is green is Find the number of blue balls
3
in the jar.
15.3 Summary
In this chapter, you have studied the following points :
1. The difference between experimental probability and theoretical probability.
2. The theoretical (classical) probability of an event E, written as P(E), is defined as
where we assume that the outcomes of the experiment are equally likely.
3. The probability of a sure event (or certain event) is 1.
4. The probability of an impossible event is 0.
5. The probability of an event E is a number P(E) such that
0 ≤ P (E) ≤ 1
6. An event having only one outcome is called an elementary event. The sum of the
probabilities of all the elementary events of an experiment is 1.
7. For any event E, P (E) + P ( E ) = 1, where E stands for ‘not E’. E and E are called
complementary events.
APPENDIX 1
ANSWERS/HINTS
EXERCISE 1.1
1. (i) 45 (ii) 196 (iii) 51
2. An integer can be of the form 6q, 6q + 1, 6q + 2, 6q + 3, 6q + 4 or 6q + 5.
3. 8 columns
4. An integer can be of the form 3q, 3q + 1 or 3q + 2. Square all of these integers.
5. An integer can be of the form 9q, 9q + 1, 9q + 2, 9q + 3, . . ., or 9q + 8.
EXERCISE 1.2
1. (i) 22 × 5 × 7 (ii) 22 × 3 × 13 (iii) 32 × 52 × 17
(iv) 5 × 7 × 11 × 13 (v) 17 × 19 × 23
2. (i) LCM = 182; HCF = 13 (ii) LCM = 23460; HCF = 2 (iii) LCM = 3024; HCF = 6
3. (i) LCM = 420; HCF = 3 (ii) LCM = 11339; HCF = 1 (iii) LCM = 1800; HCF = 1
4. 22338 7. 36 minutes
EXERCISE 1.4
1. (i) Terminating (ii) Terminating
(iii) Non-terminating repeating (iv) Terminating
(v) Non-terminating repeating (vi) Terminating
(vii) Non-terminating repeating (viii) Terminating
(ix) Terminating (x) Non-terminating repeating
2. (i) 0.00416 (ii) 2.125 (iv) 0.009375
(vi) 0.115 (viii) 0.4 (ix) 0.7
2015-16
346 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 2.1
1. (i) No zeroes (ii) 1 (iii) 3 (iv) 2 (v) 4 (vi) 3
EXERCISE 2.2
1 1
1. (i) –2, 4 (ii) , (iii) − 1 , 3
2 2 3 2
4
(iv) –2, 0 (v) − 15, 15 (vi) –1,
3
EXERCISE 2.3
1. (i) Quotient = x – 3 and remainder = 7x – 9
(ii) Quotient = x2 + x – 3 and remainder = 8
(iii) Quotient = – x2 – 2 and remainder = – 5x + 10
2. (i) Yes (ii) Yes (iii) No 3. –1, –1 4. g(x) = x2 – x + 1
5. (i) p(x) = 2x 2 – 2x + 14, g(x) = 2, q(x) = x2 – x + 7, r(x) = 0
(ii) p(x) = x 3 + x 2 + x + 1, g(x) = x2 – 1, q(x) = x + 1, r(x) = 2x + 2
(iii) p(x) = x 3 + 2x 2 – x + 2, g(x) = x 2 – 1, q(x) = x + 2, r(x) = 4
There can be several examples in each of (i), (ii) and (iii).
2. x 3 – 2x2 – 7x + 14 3. a = 1, b = ± 2
4. – 5, 7 5. k = 5 and a = –5
EXERCISE 3.1
1. Algebraically the two situations can be represented as follows:
x – 7y + 42 = 0; x – 3y – 6 = 0, where x and y are respectively the present ages of Aftab and
2015-16
ANSWERS/HINTS 347
his daughter. To represent the situations graphically, you can draw the graphs of these
two linear equations.
2. Algebraically the two situations can be represented as follows:
x + 2y = 1300; x + 3y = 1300, where x and y are respectively the costs (in `) of a bat and a
ball. To represent the situations graphically, you can draw the graphs of these two linear
equations.
3. Algebraically the two situations can be represented as follows:
2x + y = 160; 4x + 2y = 300, where x and y are respectively the prices (in ` per kg) of apples
and grapes. To represent the situations graphically, you can draw the graphs of these
two linear equations.
EXERCISE 3.2
1. (i) Required pair of linear equations is
x + y = 10; x – y = 4, where x is the number of girls and y is the number of boys.
To solve graphically draw the graphs of these equations on the same axes on graph
paper.
Girls = 7, Boys = 3.
(ii) Required pair of linear equations is
5x + 7y = 50; 7x + 5y = 46, where x and y represent the cost (in `) of a pencil and of
a pen respectively.
To solve graphically, draw the graphs of these equations on the same axes on graph
paper.
Cost of one pencil = ` 3, Cost of one pen = ` 5
2. (i) Intersect at a point (ii) Coincident (iii) Parallel
3. (i) Consistent (ii) Inconsistent (iii) Consistent
(iv) Consistent (v) Consistent
4. (i) Consistent (ii) Inconsistent (iii) Consistent (iv) Inconsistent
The solution of (i) above, is given by y = 5 – x, where x can take any value, i.e., there are
infinitely many solutions.
The solution of (iii) above is x = 2, y = 2, i.e., unique solution.
5. Length = 20 m and breadth = 16 m.
6. One possible answer for the three parts:
(i) 3x + 2y – 7 = 0 (ii) 2x + 3y – 12 = 0 (iii) 4x + 6y – 16 = 0
7. Vertices of the triangle are (–1, 0), (4, 0) and (2, 3).
2015-16
348 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 3.3
1. (i) x = 9, y = 5 (ii) s = 9, t = 6 (iii) y = 3x – 3,
where x can take any value, i.e., infinitely many solutions.
(iv) x = 2, y = 3 (v) x = 0, y = 0 (vi) x = 2, y = 3
2. x = –2, y = 5; m = –1
3. (i) x – y = 26, x = 3y, where x and y are two numbers (x > y); x = 39, y = 13.
(ii) x – y = 18, x + y = 180, where x and y are the measures of the two angles in degrees;
x = 99, y = 81.
(iii) 7x + 6y = 3800, 3x + 5y = 1750, where x and y are the costs (in `) of one bat and one
ball respectively; x = 500, y = 50.
(iv) x + 10y = 105, x + 15y = 155, where x is the fixed charge (in `) and y is the charge (in
` per km); x =5, y = 10; ` 255.
(v) 11x – 9y + 4 = 0, 6x – 5y + 3 = 0, where x and y are numerator and denominator of the
7
fraction; ( x = 7, y = 9).
9
(vi) x – 3y – 10 = 0, x – 7y + 30 = 0, where x and y are the ages in years of Jacob and his
son; x = 40, y = 10.
EXERCISE 3.4
19 6 9 5
1. (i) x = , y= (ii) x = 2, y = 1 (iii) x = ,y = −
5 5 13 13
(iv) x = 2, y = –3
2. (i) x – y + 2 = 0, 2x – y – 1 = 0, where x and y are the numerator and denominator of the
3
fraction; ⋅
5
(ii) x – 3y + 10 = 0, x – 2y – 10 = 0, where x and y are the ages (in years) of Nuri and Sonu
respectively. Age of Nuri (x) = 50, Age of Sonu (y) = 20.
(iii) x + y = 9, 8x – y = 0, where x and y are respectively the tens and units digits of the
number; 18.
(iv) x + 2y = 40, x + y = 25, where x and y are respectively the number of ` 50 and ` 100
notes; x = 10, y = 15.
(v) x + 4y = 27, x + 2y = 21, where x is the fixed charge (in ` ) and y is the additional
charge (in ` ) per day; x = 15, y = 3.
2015-16
ANSWERS/HINTS 349
EXERCISE 3.5
1. (i) No solution (ii) Unique solution; x = 2, y = 1
(iii) Infinitely many solutions (iv) Unique solution; x = 4, y = –1
2. (i) a = 5, b = 1 (ii) k = 2 3. x = –2, y = 5
4. (i) x + 20y = 1000, x + 26y = 1180, where x is the fixed charges (in ` ) and y is the charges
(in ` ) for food per day; x = 400, y = 30.
(ii) 3x – y – 3 = 0, 4x – y – 8 = 0, where x and y are the numerator and denominator of the
5
fraction; ⋅
12
(iii) 3x – y = 40, 2x – y = 25, where x and y are the number of right answers and wrong
answers respectively; 20.
(iv) u – v = 20, u + v = 100, where u and v are the speeds (in km/h) of the two cars; u = 60,
v = 40.
(v) 3x – 5y – 6 = 0, 2x + 3y – 61 = 0, where x and y are respectively the length and breadth
(in units) of the rectangle; length (x) = 17, breadth (y) = 9.
EXERCISE 3.6
1,
1. (i) x = 1 , y = 1 (ii) x = 4, y = 9 (iii) x = y= –2
2 3 5
(iv) x = 4, y = 5 (v) x = 1, y = 1 (vi) x = 1, y = 2
(vii) x = 3, y = 2 (viii) x = 1, y = 1
2. (i) u + v = 10, u – v = 2, where u and v are respectively speeds (in km/h) of rowing and
current; u = 6, v = 4.
2 5 1, 3 6 1,
(ii) + = + = where n and m are the number of days taken by 1 woman
n m 4 n m 3
and 1 man to finish the embroidery work; n = 18, m = 36.
60 240 100 200 25 ,
(iii) + = 4, + = where u and v are respectively the speeds
u v u v 6
(in km/h) of the train and bus; u = 60, v = 80.
2015-16
350 MATHEMATICS
c ( a − b) − b , c (a − b) + a
7. (i) x = 1, y = – 1 (ii) x = 2 2
y=
a −b a 2 − b2
2ab
(iii) x = a, y = b (iv) x = a + b, y = − (v) x = 2, y = 1
a+b
8. ∠ A = 120°, ∠ B = 70°, ∠ C = 60°, ∠ D = 110°
EXERCISE 4.1
1. (i) Yes (ii) Yes (iii) No (iv) Yes
(v) Yes (vi) No (vii) No (viii) Yes
2
2. (i) 2x + x – 528 = 0, where x is breadth (in metres) of the plot.
(ii) x2 + x – 306 = 0, where x is the smaller integer.
(iii) x2 + 32x – 273 = 0, where x (in years) is the present age of Rohan.
(iv) u2 – 8u – 1280 = 0, where u (in km/h) is the speed of the train.
EXERCISE 4.2
3 5 ,
1. (i) – 2, 5 (ii) – 2, (iii) − − 2
2 2
1, 1 1 , 1
(iv) (v)
4 4 10 10
2. (i) 9, 36 (ii) 25, 30
3. Numbers are 13 and 14. 4. Positive integers are 13 and 14.
5. 5 cm and 12 cm 6. Number of articles = 6, Cost of each article = Rs 15
EXERCISE 4.3
1, −1 − 33 , −1 + 33
1. (i) 3 (ii) (iii) − 3 , − 3
2 4 4 2 2
(iv) Do not exist
3 − 13 , 3 + 13
2. Same as 1 3. (i) (ii) 1, 2 4. 7 years
2 2
2015-16
ANSWERS/HINTS 351
EXERCISE 4.4
3± 3
1. (i) Real roots do not exist (ii) Equal roots; 2 , 2 (iii) Distinct roots;
3 3 2
2. (i) k = ± 2 6 (ii) k = 6
3. Yes. 40 m, 20 m 4. No 5. Yes. 20 m, 20 m
EXERCISE 5.1
1. (i) Yes. 15, 23, 31, . . . forms an AP as each succeeding term is obtained by adding 8 in
its preceding term.
2
3V , 3
(ii) No. Volumes are V, V, L (iii) Yes. 150, 200, 250, . . . form an AP.
4 4
2 3
8 , 8 , 8 ,
(iv) No. Amounts are 10000 1 + 10000 1 + 10000 1 + L
100 100 100
2. (i) 10, 20, 30, 40 (ii) – 2, – 2, – 2, – 2 (iii) 4, 1, – 2, – 5
1 1 1
(vii) Yes. d = – 4; – 16, – 20, – 24 (viii) Yes. d = 0; − , − , −
2 2 2
2015-16
352 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 5.2
1. (i) an = 28 (ii) d = 2 (iii) a = 46 (iv) n = 10 (v) an = 3.5
2. (i) C (ii) B
(iv) – 2 , 0 , 2 , 4 (v) 53 , 23 , 8 , –7
4. 16th term 5. (i) 34 (ii) 27
6. No 7. 178 8. 64
9. 5th term 10. 1 11. 65th term
12. 100 13. 128 14. 60
15. 13 16. 4, 10, 16, 22, . . .
17. 20th term from the last term is 158.
18. –13, –8, –3 19. 11th year 20. 10
EXERCISE 5.3
33
1. (i) 245 (ii) –180 (iii) 5505 (iv)
20
1
2. (i) 1046 (ii) 286 (iii) – 8930
2
7,
3. (i) n = 16, Sn = 440 (ii) d = S = 273 (iii) a = 4, S12 = 246
3 13
35 , 85
(iv) d = –1, a10 = 8 (v) a = − a9 = (vi) n = 5, an = 34
3 3
54
(vii) n = 6, d = (viii) n = 7, a = – 8 (ix) d = 6
5
(x) a = 4
2015-16
ANSWERS/HINTS 353
n
4. 12. By putting a = 9, d = 8, S = 636 in the formula S = [2a + ( n − 1) d ], we get a quadratic
2
53
equation 4n2 + 5n – 636 = 0. On solving, we get n = − , 12 . Out of these two roots only
4
one root 12 is admissible.
8
5. n = 16, d = 6. n = 38, S = 6973 7. Sum = 1661
3
8. S51 = 5610 9. n2 10. (i) S15 = 525 (ii) S15 = – 465
11. S1 = 3, S2 = 4; a2 = S2 – S 1 = 1; S3 = 3, a3 = S 3 – S2 = –1,
a10 = S10 – S9 = – 15; an = Sn – Sn – 1 = 5 – 2n.
12. 4920 13. 960 14. 625 15. ` 27750
16. Values of the prizes (in ` ) are 160, 140, 120, 100, 80, 60, 40.
17. 234 18. 143 cm
19. 16 rows, 5 logs are placed in the top row. By putting S = 200, a = 20, d = –1 in the formula
n
S = [2a + ( n − 1) d ], we get, 41n – n2 = 400. On solving, n = 16, 25. Therefore, the
2
number of rows is either 16 or 25. a25 = a + 24 d = – 4
i.e., number of logs in 25th row is – 4 which is not possible. Therefore n = 25 is not
possible. For n = 16, a16 = 5. Therefore, there are 16 rows and 5 logs placed in the top
row.
20. 370 m
EXERCISE 6.1
1. (i) Similar (ii) Similar (iii) Equilateral
(iv) Equal, Proportional 3. No
EXERCISE 6.2
1. (i) 2 cm (ii) 2.4 cm
2. (i) No (ii) Yes (iiii) Yes
9. Through O, draw a line parallel to DC, intersecting AD and BC at E and F respectively.
2015-16
354 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 6.3
1. (i) Yes. AAA, ∆ ABC ~ ∆ PQR (ii) Yes. SSS, ∆ ABC ~ ∆ QRP
(iii) No (iv) Yes. SAS, ∆ MNL ~ ∆ QPR
(v) No (vi) Yes. AA, ∆ DEF ~ ∆ PQR
2. 55°, 55°, 55°
14. Produce AD to a point E such that AD = DE and produce PM to a point N such that
PM = MN. Join EC and NR.
15. 42 m
EXERCISE 6.4
1. 11.2 cm 2. 4 : 1 5. 1 : 4 8. C 9. D
EXERCISE 6.5
1. (i) Yes, 25 cm (ii) No (iii) No (iv) Yes, 13 cm
EXERCISE 7.1
7. (– 7, 0) 8. – 9, 3 9. ± 4, QR = 41, PR = 82 , 9 2
10. 3x + y – 5 = 0
EXERCISE 7.2
5 7
1. (1, 3) 2. 2, − ; 0, −
3 3
2015-16
ANSWERS/HINTS 355
5. 1: 1 ; − 3 , 0 6. x = 6, y = 3 7. (3, – 10)
2
EXERCISE 7.3
21
1. (i) sq. units (ii) 32 sq. units 2. (i) k = 4 (ii) k = 3
2
3. 1 sq. unit; 1 : 4 4. 28 sq. units
6. 15 sq. units; 1 : 16
32
7 9 11 11
7. (i) D , (ii) P ,
2 2 3 3
EXERCISE 8.1
7, 3 15 , 17
2. 0 3. cos A = tan A = 4. sin A = sec A =
4 7 17 8
2015-16
356 MATHEMATICS
5 12 , 5 12 , 13
5. sin θ = , cos θ = tan θ = , cot θ = cosec θ =
13 13 12 5 5
49 49
7. (i) (ii) 8. Yes
64 64
12 , 5 , 12
9. (i) 1 (ii) 0 10. sin P = cos P = tan P =
13 13 5
11. (i) False (ii) True (iii) False (iv) False (v) False
EXERCISE 8.2
3 2 − 6 43 − 24 3 67
1. (i) 1 (ii) 2 (iii) (iv) (v)
8 11 12
2. (i) A (ii) D (iii) A (iv) C 3. ∠ A = 45°, ∠ B = 15°
4. (i) False (ii) True (iii) False (iv) False (v) True
EXERCISE 8.3
1. (i) 1 (ii) 1 (iii) 0 (iv) 0
3. ∠ A = 36° 5. ∠ A = 22° 7. cos 23° + sin 15°
EXERCISE 8.4
1 1 , 1 + cot2 A
1. sin A = , tanA = secA =
1 + cot2 A cot A cot A
sec 2 A – 1 , 1 ,
2. sin A = cos A = tan A = sec 2 A – 1
sec A sec A
1 , cosecA = sec A
cot A =
2
sec A – 1 sec2 A – 1
EXERCISE 9.1
1. 10 m 2. 8 3 m 3. 3m, 2 3 m 4. 10 3m
2015-16
ANSWERS/HINTS 357
5. 40 3m 6. 19 3 m 7. 20 ( )
3 −1 m 8. 0.8 ( 3 +1 m)
9. 16 2 m 10. 20 3m, 20m, 60m 11. 10 3 m, 10 m 12. 7 ( 3 +1 m)
3
EXERCISE 10.1
1. Infinitely many
2. (i) One (ii) Secant (iii) Two (iv) Point of contact 3. D
EXERCISE 10.2
1. A 2. B 3. A 6. 3 cm
7. 8 cm 12. AB = 15 cm, AC = 13 cm
EXERCISE 12.1
1. 28 cm 2. 10 cm
3. Gold : 346.5 cm ; Red : 1039.5 cm2; Blue : 1732.5 cm2; Black : 2425.5 cm2; White : 3118.5 cm2.
2
4. 4375 5. A
EXERCISE 12.2
132 2 77 154 2
1. cm 2. cm 2 3. cm
7 8 3
4. (i) 28.5 cm2 (ii) 235.5 cm2
441 3 2
5. (i) 22 cm (ii) 231 cm2 (iii) 231 − cm
4
2015-16
358 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 12.3
4523 2 154 2
1. cm 2. cm 3. 42 cm2
28 3
22528
4. 660 + 36 3 cm2 5. 68 cm 2 6. − 768 3 cm2
7 7 7
77 49
12. (i) cm2 (ii) cm2 13. 228 cm 2
8 8
256
14. 308 cm 2 15. 98 cm2 16. cm2
3 7
EXERCISE 13.1
1. 160 cm2 2. 572 cm2 3. 214.5 cm2
4. Greatest diameter = 7 cm,surface area = 332.5 cm2
EXERCISE 13.2
1. π cm3
2. 66 cm3. Volume of the air inside the model = Volume of air inside (cone + cylinder + cone)
1 1
= π r2 h1 + π r 2h2 + π r 2 h1 , where r is the radius of the cone and the cylinder, h1 is
3 3
the height (length) of the cone and h2 is the height (length) of the cylinder.
1
Required Volume = π r 2 ( h1 + 3 h2 + h1 ) .
3
3. 338 cm3 4. 523.53 cm3 5. 100 6. 892.26 kg
3 3
7. 1.131 m (approx.) 8. Not correct. Correct answer is 346.51 cm .
2015-16
ANSWERS/HINTS 359
EXERCISE 13.3
1. 2.74 cm 2. 12 cm 3. 2.5 m
4. 1.125 m 5. 10 6. 400
7. 36cm; 12 13 cm 8. 562500 m2 or 56.25 hectares. 9. 100 minutes
EXERCISE 13.4
2 2
1. 102 cm3 2. 48 cm2 3. 710 cm 2
3 7
4. Cost of milk is ` 209 and cost of metal sheet is ` 156.75. 5. 7964.4 m
4
3. 1792 5. 782 cm 2
7
EXERCISE 14.1
1. 8.1 plants. We have used direct method because numerical values of x i and fi are small.
2. ` 145.20 3. f = 20 4. 75.9
5. 57.19 6. ` 211 7. 0.099 ppm
8. 12.38 days 9. 69.43 %
EXERCISE 14.2
1. Mode = 36.8 years, Mean = 35.37 years. Maximum number of patients admitted in the
hospital are of the age 36.8 years (approx.), while on an average the age of a patient
admitted to the hospital is 35.37 years.
2. 65.625 hours
3. Modal monthly expenditure = ` 1847.83, Mean monthly expenditure = ` 2662.5.
4. Mode : 30.6, Mean = 29.2. Most states/U.T. have a student teacher ratio of 30.6 and on
an average, this ratio is 29.2.
5. Mode = 4608.7 runs 6. Mode = 44.7 cars
EXERCISE 14.3
1. Median = 137 units, Mean = 137.05 units, Mode = 135.76 units.
The three measures are approximately the same in this case.
2015-16
360 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE 14.4
1.
Daily income (in `) Cumulative
frequency
2. Draw the ogive by plotting the points : (38, 0), (40, 3), (42, 5), (44, 9), (46, 14), (48, 28),
n
(50, 32) and (52, 35). Here = 17.5. Locate the point on the ogive whose ordinate is 17.5.
2
The x-coordinate of this point will be the median.
3.
Now, draw the ogive by plotting the points : (50, 100), (55, 98), (60, 90), (65, 78), (70, 54)
and (75, 16).
2015-16
ANSWERS/HINTS 361
EXERCISE 15.1
1. (i) 1 (ii) 0, impossible event (iii) 1, sure or certain event
(iv) 1 (v) 0, 1
2. The experiments (iii) and (iv) have equally likely outcomes.
3. When we toss a coin, the outcomes head and tail are equally likely. So, the result of an
individual coin toss is completely unpredictable.
4. B 5. 0.95 6. (i) 0 (ii) 1
3 5
7. 0.008 8. (i) (ii)
8 8
5 8 13 5 17
9. (i) (ii) (iii) 10. (i) (ii)
17 17 17 9 18
5 1 1 3
11. 12. (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) 1
13 8 2 4
1 1 1
13. (i) (ii) (iii)
2 2 2
1 3 3 1 1 1
14. (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) (vi)
26 13 26 52 4 52
1 1 11
15. (i) (ii) (a) (b) 0 16.
5 4 12
1 15 9 1 1
17. (i) (ii) 18. (i) (ii) (iii)
5 19 10 10 5
1 1 π 31 5
19. (i) (ii) 20. 21. (i) (ii)
3 6 24 36 36
22. (i)
Sum on 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
2 dice
1 2 3 4 5 6 5 4 3 2 1
Probability
36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36 36
2015-16
362 MATHEMATICS
3
23. ; Possible outcomes are : HHH, TTT, HHT, HTH, HTT, THH, THT, TTH. Here, THH
4
means tail in the first toss, head on the second toss and head on the third toss and so on.
25 11
24. (i) (ii)
36 36
25. (i) Incorrect. We can classify the outcomes like this but they are not then ‘equally
likely’. Reason is that ‘one of each’ can result in two ways — from a head on first
coin and tail on the second coin or from a tail on the first coin and head on the
second coin. This makes it twicely as likely as two heads (or two tails).
(ii) Correct. The two outcomes considered in the question are equally likely.
8
1. (i) 1 (ii) (iii) 4
5 25 5
2. 1 2 2 3 3 6
1 2 3 3 4 4 7
2 3 4 4 5 5 8
2 3 4 4 5 5 8
3 4 5 5 6 6 9
3 4 5 5 6 6 9
6 7 8 8 9 9 12
1 1 5
(i) (ii) (iii)
2 9 12
x,
3. 10 4. x=3 5. 8
12
EXERCISE A1.1
1. (i) Ambiguous (ii) True (iii) True (iv) Ambiguous
(v) Ambiguous
2015-16
ANSWERS/HINTS 363
2. (i) True (ii) True (iii) False (iv) True (v) True
3. Only (ii) is true.
4. (i) If a > 0 and a2 > b2, then a > b.
(ii) If xy > 0 and x2 = y2, then x = y.
(iii) If (x + y)2 = x 2 + y 2 and y ≠ 0, then x = 0.
(iv) The diagonals of a parallelogram bisect each other.
EXERCISE A1.2
1. A is mortal 2. ab is rational
7. Yes, because of the premise. No, because 3721 = 61 which is not irrational. Since the
premise was wrong, the conclusion is false.
EXERCISE A1.3
1. Take two consecutive odd numbers as 2n + 1 and 2n + 3 for some integer n.
EXERCISE A1.4
1. (i) Man is not mortal.
(ii) Line l is not parallel to line m.
(iii) The chapter does not have many exercises.
(iv) Not all integers are rational numbers.
(v) All prime numbers are not odd.
(vi) Some students are lazy.
(vii) All cats are black.
2015-16
364 MATHEMATICS
EXERCISE A1.5
1. (i) If Sharan sweats a lot, then it is hot in Tokyo.
(ii) If Shalini’s stomach grumbles, then she is hungry.
(iii) If Jaswant can get a degree, then she has a scholarship.
(iv) If a plant is alive, then it has flowers.
(v) If an animal has a tail, then it is a cat.
2. (i) If the base angles of triangle ABC are equal, then it is isosceles. True.
(ii) If the square of an integer is odd, then the integer is odd. True.
(iii) If x = 1, then x2 = 1. True.
(iv) If AC and BD bisect each other, then ABCD is a parallelogram. True.
(v) If a + (b + c) = (a + b) + c, then a, b and c are whole numbers. False.
(vi) If x + y is an even number, then x and y are odd. False.
(vii) If a parallelogram is a rectangle, its vertices lie on a circle. True.
EXERCISE A1.6
1. Suppose to the contrary b ≤ d.
3. See Example 10 of Chapter 1.
6. See Theorem 5.1 of Class IX Mathematics Textbook.
EXERCISE A2.2
1
1. (i) (ii) 160
5
2. Take 1 cm2 area and count the number of dots in it. Total number of trees will be the
product of this number and the area (in cm2).
3. Rate of interest in instalment scheme is 17.74 %, which is less than 18 %.
EXERCISE A2.3
1. Students find their own answers.
2015-16